Mercurial > emacs
annotate lispref/text.texi @ 33462:d8cd8e1bc659
(current_mode_line_height, current_header_line_height):
New variables.
(init_xdisp): Initialize them.
(pos_visible_p): Add parameter EXACT_MODE_LINE_HEIGHTS_P. Compute
and use exact mode line heights if it is set.
author | Gerd Moellmann <gerd@gnu.org> |
---|---|
date | Tue, 14 Nov 2000 05:43:18 +0000 |
parents | 0c00f9d38595 |
children | 10fd9a833957 |
rev | line source |
---|---|
6558 | 1 @c -*-texinfo-*- |
2 @c This is part of the GNU Emacs Lisp Reference Manual. | |
31079 | 3 @c Copyright (C) 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1998, 1999, 2000 |
27189 | 4 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc. |
6558 | 5 @c See the file elisp.texi for copying conditions. |
6 @setfilename ../info/text | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
7 @node Text, Non-ASCII Characters, Markers, Top |
6558 | 8 @chapter Text |
9 @cindex text | |
10 | |
11 This chapter describes the functions that deal with the text in a | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
12 buffer. Most examine, insert, or delete text in the current buffer, |
24951
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
13 often operating at point or on text adjacent to point. Many are |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
14 interactive. All the functions that change the text provide for undoing |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
15 the changes (@pxref{Undo}). |
6558 | 16 |
17 Many text-related functions operate on a region of text defined by two | |
18 buffer positions passed in arguments named @var{start} and @var{end}. | |
19 These arguments should be either markers (@pxref{Markers}) or numeric | |
20 character positions (@pxref{Positions}). The order of these arguments | |
21 does not matter; it is all right for @var{start} to be the end of the | |
22 region and @var{end} the beginning. For example, @code{(delete-region 1 | |
23 10)} and @code{(delete-region 10 1)} are equivalent. An | |
24 @code{args-out-of-range} error is signaled if either @var{start} or | |
25 @var{end} is outside the accessible portion of the buffer. In an | |
26 interactive call, point and the mark are used for these arguments. | |
27 | |
28 @cindex buffer contents | |
29 Throughout this chapter, ``text'' refers to the characters in the | |
24951
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
30 buffer, together with their properties (when relevant). Keep in mind |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
31 that point is always between two characters, and the cursor appears on |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
32 the character after point. |
6558 | 33 |
34 @menu | |
35 * Near Point:: Examining text in the vicinity of point. | |
36 * Buffer Contents:: Examining text in a general fashion. | |
37 * Comparing Text:: Comparing substrings of buffers. | |
38 * Insertion:: Adding new text to a buffer. | |
39 * Commands for Insertion:: User-level commands to insert text. | |
40 * Deletion:: Removing text from a buffer. | |
41 * User-Level Deletion:: User-level commands to delete text. | |
42 * The Kill Ring:: Where removed text sometimes is saved for later use. | |
43 * Undo:: Undoing changes to the text of a buffer. | |
44 * Maintaining Undo:: How to enable and disable undo information. | |
45 How to control how much information is kept. | |
46 * Filling:: Functions for explicit filling. | |
12098 | 47 * Margins:: How to specify margins for filling commands. |
23147 | 48 * Adaptive Fill:: Adaptive Fill mode chooses a fill prefix from context. |
6558 | 49 * Auto Filling:: How auto-fill mode is implemented to break lines. |
50 * Sorting:: Functions for sorting parts of the buffer. | |
51 * Columns:: Computing horizontal positions, and using them. | |
52 * Indentation:: Functions to insert or adjust indentation. | |
53 * Case Changes:: Case conversion of parts of the buffer. | |
54 * Text Properties:: Assigning Lisp property lists to text characters. | |
55 * Substitution:: Replacing a given character wherever it appears. | |
7735
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
56 * Transposition:: Swapping two portions of a buffer. |
6558 | 57 * Registers:: How registers are implemented. Accessing the text or |
58 position stored in a register. | |
24951
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
59 * Base 64:: Conversion to or from base 64 encoding. |
6558 | 60 * Change Hooks:: Supplying functions to be run when text is changed. |
61 @end menu | |
62 | |
63 @node Near Point | |
64 @section Examining Text Near Point | |
65 | |
66 Many functions are provided to look at the characters around point. | |
67 Several simple functions are described here. See also @code{looking-at} | |
68 in @ref{Regexp Search}. | |
69 | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
70 @defun char-after &optional position |
6558 | 71 This function returns the character in the current buffer at (i.e., |
72 immediately after) position @var{position}. If @var{position} is out of | |
73 range for this purpose, either before the beginning of the buffer, or at | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
74 or beyond the end, then the value is @code{nil}. The default for |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
75 @var{position} is point. |
6558 | 76 |
77 In the following example, assume that the first character in the | |
78 buffer is @samp{@@}: | |
79 | |
80 @example | |
81 @group | |
82 (char-to-string (char-after 1)) | |
83 @result{} "@@" | |
84 @end group | |
85 @end example | |
86 @end defun | |
87 | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
88 @defun char-before &optional position |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
89 This function returns the character in the current buffer immediately |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
90 before position @var{position}. If @var{position} is out of range for |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
91 this purpose, either before the beginning of the buffer, or at or beyond |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
92 the end, then the value is @code{nil}. The default for |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
93 @var{position} is point. |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
94 @end defun |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
95 |
6558 | 96 @defun following-char |
97 This function returns the character following point in the current | |
98 buffer. This is similar to @code{(char-after (point))}. However, if | |
99 point is at the end of the buffer, then @code{following-char} returns 0. | |
100 | |
101 Remember that point is always between characters, and the terminal | |
102 cursor normally appears over the character following point. Therefore, | |
103 the character returned by @code{following-char} is the character the | |
104 cursor is over. | |
105 | |
106 In this example, point is between the @samp{a} and the @samp{c}. | |
107 | |
108 @example | |
109 @group | |
110 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
111 Gentlemen may cry ``Pea@point{}ce! Peace!,'' | |
112 but there is no peace. | |
113 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
114 @end group | |
115 | |
116 @group | |
117 (char-to-string (preceding-char)) | |
118 @result{} "a" | |
119 (char-to-string (following-char)) | |
120 @result{} "c" | |
121 @end group | |
122 @end example | |
123 @end defun | |
124 | |
125 @defun preceding-char | |
126 This function returns the character preceding point in the current | |
127 buffer. See above, under @code{following-char}, for an example. If | |
128 point is at the beginning of the buffer, @code{preceding-char} returns | |
129 0. | |
130 @end defun | |
131 | |
132 @defun bobp | |
133 This function returns @code{t} if point is at the beginning of the | |
134 buffer. If narrowing is in effect, this means the beginning of the | |
135 accessible portion of the text. See also @code{point-min} in | |
136 @ref{Point}. | |
137 @end defun | |
138 | |
139 @defun eobp | |
140 This function returns @code{t} if point is at the end of the buffer. | |
141 If narrowing is in effect, this means the end of accessible portion of | |
142 the text. See also @code{point-max} in @xref{Point}. | |
143 @end defun | |
144 | |
145 @defun bolp | |
146 This function returns @code{t} if point is at the beginning of a line. | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
147 @xref{Text Lines}. The beginning of the buffer (or of its accessible |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
148 portion) always counts as the beginning of a line. |
6558 | 149 @end defun |
150 | |
151 @defun eolp | |
152 This function returns @code{t} if point is at the end of a line. The | |
153 end of the buffer (or of its accessible portion) is always considered | |
154 the end of a line. | |
155 @end defun | |
156 | |
157 @node Buffer Contents | |
158 @section Examining Buffer Contents | |
159 | |
160 This section describes two functions that allow a Lisp program to | |
161 convert any portion of the text in the buffer into a string. | |
162 | |
163 @defun buffer-substring start end | |
164 This function returns a string containing a copy of the text of the | |
165 region defined by positions @var{start} and @var{end} in the current | |
166 buffer. If the arguments are not positions in the accessible portion of | |
167 the buffer, @code{buffer-substring} signals an @code{args-out-of-range} | |
168 error. | |
169 | |
170 It is not necessary for @var{start} to be less than @var{end}; the | |
171 arguments can be given in either order. But most often the smaller | |
172 argument is written first. | |
173 | |
12067 | 174 If the text being copied has any text properties, these are copied into |
175 the string along with the characters they belong to. @xref{Text | |
176 Properties}. However, overlays (@pxref{Overlays}) in the buffer and | |
177 their properties are ignored, not copied. | |
178 | |
6558 | 179 @example |
180 @group | |
181 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
182 This is the contents of buffer foo | |
183 | |
184 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
185 @end group | |
186 | |
187 @group | |
188 (buffer-substring 1 10) | |
189 @result{} "This is t" | |
190 @end group | |
191 @group | |
192 (buffer-substring (point-max) 10) | |
193 @result{} "he contents of buffer foo | |
194 " | |
195 @end group | |
196 @end example | |
197 @end defun | |
198 | |
13109
acb0ab49f4e7
Fix name of buffer-substring-no-properties.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12775
diff
changeset
|
199 @defun buffer-substring-no-properties start end |
12067 | 200 This is like @code{buffer-substring}, except that it does not copy text |
201 properties, just the characters themselves. @xref{Text Properties}. | |
202 @end defun | |
203 | |
6558 | 204 @defun buffer-string |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
205 This function returns the contents of the entire accessible portion of |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
206 the current buffer as a string. It is equivalent to |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
207 |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
208 @example |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
209 (buffer-substring (point-min) (point-max)) |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
210 @end example |
6558 | 211 |
212 @example | |
213 @group | |
214 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
215 This is the contents of buffer foo | |
216 | |
217 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
218 | |
219 (buffer-string) | |
220 @result{} "This is the contents of buffer foo | |
221 " | |
222 @end group | |
223 @end example | |
224 @end defun | |
225 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
226 @defun thing-at-point thing |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
227 Return the @var{thing} around or next to point, as a string. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
228 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
229 The argument @var{thing} is a symbol which specifies a kind of syntactic |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
230 entity. Possibilities include @code{symbol}, @code{list}, @code{sexp}, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
231 @code{defun}, @code{filename}, @code{url}, @code{word}, @code{sentence}, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
232 @code{whitespace}, @code{line}, @code{page}, and others. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
233 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
234 @example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
235 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
236 Gentlemen may cry ``Pea@point{}ce! Peace!,'' |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
237 but there is no peace. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
238 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
239 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
240 (thing-at-point 'word) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
241 @result{} "Peace" |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
242 (thing-at-point 'line) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
243 @result{} "Gentlemen may cry ``Peace! Peace!,''\n" |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
244 (thing-at-point 'whitespace) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
245 @result{} nil |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
246 @end example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
247 @end defun |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
248 |
6558 | 249 @node Comparing Text |
250 @section Comparing Text | |
251 @cindex comparing buffer text | |
252 | |
253 This function lets you compare portions of the text in a buffer, without | |
254 copying them into strings first. | |
255 | |
256 @defun compare-buffer-substrings buffer1 start1 end1 buffer2 start2 end2 | |
257 This function lets you compare two substrings of the same buffer or two | |
258 different buffers. The first three arguments specify one substring, | |
259 giving a buffer and two positions within the buffer. The last three | |
260 arguments specify the other substring in the same way. You can use | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
261 @code{nil} for @var{buffer1}, @var{buffer2}, or both to stand for the |
6558 | 262 current buffer. |
263 | |
264 The value is negative if the first substring is less, positive if the | |
265 first is greater, and zero if they are equal. The absolute value of | |
266 the result is one plus the index of the first differing characters | |
267 within the substrings. | |
268 | |
269 This function ignores case when comparing characters | |
12098 | 270 if @code{case-fold-search} is non-@code{nil}. It always ignores |
271 text properties. | |
6558 | 272 |
273 Suppose the current buffer contains the text @samp{foobarbar | |
274 haha!rara!}; then in this example the two substrings are @samp{rbar } | |
275 and @samp{rara!}. The value is 2 because the first substring is greater | |
276 at the second character. | |
277 | |
278 @example | |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
279 (compare-buffer-substrings nil 6 11 nil 16 21) |
6558 | 280 @result{} 2 |
281 @end example | |
282 @end defun | |
283 | |
284 @node Insertion | |
12098 | 285 @section Inserting Text |
6558 | 286 @cindex insertion of text |
287 @cindex text insertion | |
288 | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
289 @cindex insertion before point |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
290 @cindex before point, insertion |
6558 | 291 @dfn{Insertion} means adding new text to a buffer. The inserted text |
292 goes at point---between the character before point and the character | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
293 after point. Some insertion functions leave point before the inserted |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
294 text, while other functions leave it after. We call the former |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
295 insertion @dfn{after point} and the latter insertion @dfn{before point}. |
6558 | 296 |
297 Insertion relocates markers that point at positions after the | |
298 insertion point, so that they stay with the surrounding text | |
299 (@pxref{Markers}). When a marker points at the place of insertion, | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
300 insertion may or may not relocate the marker, depending on the marker's |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
301 insertion type (@pxref{Marker Insertion Types}). Certain special |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
302 functions such as @code{insert-before-markers} relocate all such markers |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
303 to point after the inserted text, regardless of the markers' insertion |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
304 type. |
6558 | 305 |
306 Insertion functions signal an error if the current buffer is | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
307 read-only or if they insert within read-only text. |
6558 | 308 |
12098 | 309 These functions copy text characters from strings and buffers along |
310 with their properties. The inserted characters have exactly the same | |
311 properties as the characters they were copied from. By contrast, | |
312 characters specified as separate arguments, not part of a string or | |
313 buffer, inherit their text properties from the neighboring text. | |
314 | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
315 The insertion functions convert text from unibyte to multibyte in |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
316 order to insert in a multibyte buffer, and vice versa---if the text |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
317 comes from a string or from a buffer. However, they do not convert |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
318 unibyte character codes 128 through 255 to multibyte characters, not |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
319 even if the current buffer is a multibyte buffer. @xref{Converting |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
320 Representations}. |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
321 |
6558 | 322 @defun insert &rest args |
323 This function inserts the strings and/or characters @var{args} into the | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
324 current buffer, at point, moving point forward. In other words, it |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
325 inserts the text before point. An error is signaled unless all |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
326 @var{args} are either strings or characters. The value is @code{nil}. |
6558 | 327 @end defun |
328 | |
329 @defun insert-before-markers &rest args | |
330 This function inserts the strings and/or characters @var{args} into the | |
331 current buffer, at point, moving point forward. An error is signaled | |
332 unless all @var{args} are either strings or characters. The value is | |
333 @code{nil}. | |
334 | |
335 This function is unlike the other insertion functions in that it | |
336 relocates markers initially pointing at the insertion point, to point | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
337 after the inserted text. If an overlay begins the insertion point, the |
16934
853f638bbc81
Document how insert-before-markers affects overlays.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16736
diff
changeset
|
338 inserted text falls outside the overlay; if a nonempty overlay ends at |
853f638bbc81
Document how insert-before-markers affects overlays.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16736
diff
changeset
|
339 the insertion point, the inserted text falls inside that overlay. |
6558 | 340 @end defun |
341 | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
342 @defun insert-char character &optional count inherit |
6558 | 343 This function inserts @var{count} instances of @var{character} into the |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
344 current buffer before point. The argument @var{count} should be a |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
345 number (@code{nil} means 1), and @var{character} must be a character. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
346 The value is @code{nil}. |
8644 | 347 |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
348 This function does not convert unibyte character codes 128 through 255 |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
349 to multibyte characters, not even if the current buffer is a multibyte |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
350 buffer. @xref{Converting Representations}. |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
351 |
8644 | 352 If @var{inherit} is non-@code{nil}, then the inserted characters inherit |
353 sticky text properties from the two characters before and after the | |
354 insertion point. @xref{Sticky Properties}. | |
6558 | 355 @end defun |
356 | |
357 @defun insert-buffer-substring from-buffer-or-name &optional start end | |
358 This function inserts a portion of buffer @var{from-buffer-or-name} | |
359 (which must already exist) into the current buffer before point. The | |
360 text inserted is the region from @var{start} and @var{end}. (These | |
361 arguments default to the beginning and end of the accessible portion of | |
362 that buffer.) This function returns @code{nil}. | |
363 | |
364 In this example, the form is executed with buffer @samp{bar} as the | |
365 current buffer. We assume that buffer @samp{bar} is initially empty. | |
366 | |
367 @example | |
368 @group | |
369 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
370 We hold these truths to be self-evident, that all | |
371 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
372 @end group | |
373 | |
374 @group | |
375 (insert-buffer-substring "foo" 1 20) | |
376 @result{} nil | |
377 | |
378 ---------- Buffer: bar ---------- | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
379 We hold these truth@point{} |
6558 | 380 ---------- Buffer: bar ---------- |
381 @end group | |
382 @end example | |
383 @end defun | |
384 | |
385 @xref{Sticky Properties}, for other insertion functions that inherit | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
386 text properties from the nearby text in addition to inserting it. |
8644 | 387 Whitespace inserted by indentation functions also inherits text |
388 properties. | |
6558 | 389 |
390 @node Commands for Insertion | |
391 @section User-Level Insertion Commands | |
392 | |
393 This section describes higher-level commands for inserting text, | |
394 commands intended primarily for the user but useful also in Lisp | |
395 programs. | |
396 | |
397 @deffn Command insert-buffer from-buffer-or-name | |
398 This command inserts the entire contents of @var{from-buffer-or-name} | |
399 (which must exist) into the current buffer after point. It leaves | |
400 the mark after the inserted text. The value is @code{nil}. | |
401 @end deffn | |
402 | |
403 @deffn Command self-insert-command count | |
404 @cindex character insertion | |
405 @cindex self-insertion | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
406 This command inserts the last character typed; it does so @var{count} |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
407 times, before point, and returns @code{nil}. Most printing characters |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
408 are bound to this command. In routine use, @code{self-insert-command} |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
409 is the most frequently called function in Emacs, but programs rarely use |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
410 it except to install it on a keymap. |
6558 | 411 |
412 In an interactive call, @var{count} is the numeric prefix argument. | |
413 | |
12067 | 414 This command calls @code{auto-fill-function} whenever that is |
28843 | 415 non-@code{nil} and the character inserted is in the table |
416 @code{auto-fill-chars} (@pxref{Auto Filling}). | |
6558 | 417 |
418 @c Cross refs reworded to prevent overfull hbox. --rjc 15mar92 | |
12067 | 419 This command performs abbrev expansion if Abbrev mode is enabled and |
6558 | 420 the inserted character does not have word-constituent |
421 syntax. (@xref{Abbrevs}, and @ref{Syntax Class Table}.) | |
422 | |
12067 | 423 This is also responsible for calling @code{blink-paren-function} when |
424 the inserted character has close parenthesis syntax (@pxref{Blinking}). | |
25875 | 425 |
426 Do not try substituting your own definition of | |
427 @code{self-insert-command} for the standard one. The editor command | |
428 loop handles this function specially. | |
6558 | 429 @end deffn |
430 | |
431 @deffn Command newline &optional number-of-newlines | |
432 This command inserts newlines into the current buffer before point. | |
433 If @var{number-of-newlines} is supplied, that many newline characters | |
434 are inserted. | |
435 | |
436 @cindex newline and Auto Fill mode | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
437 This function calls @code{auto-fill-function} if the current column |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
438 number is greater than the value of @code{fill-column} and |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
439 @var{number-of-newlines} is @code{nil}. Typically what |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
440 @code{auto-fill-function} does is insert a newline; thus, the overall |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
441 result in this case is to insert two newlines at different places: one |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
442 at point, and another earlier in the line. @code{newline} does not |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
443 auto-fill if @var{number-of-newlines} is non-@code{nil}. |
6558 | 444 |
12098 | 445 This command indents to the left margin if that is not zero. |
446 @xref{Margins}. | |
447 | |
6558 | 448 The value returned is @code{nil}. In an interactive call, @var{count} |
449 is the numeric prefix argument. | |
450 @end deffn | |
451 | |
452 @deffn Command split-line | |
453 This command splits the current line, moving the portion of the line | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
454 after point down vertically so that it is on the next line directly |
6558 | 455 below where it was before. Whitespace is inserted as needed at the |
456 beginning of the lower line, using the @code{indent-to} function. | |
457 @code{split-line} returns the position of point. | |
458 | |
459 Programs hardly ever use this function. | |
460 @end deffn | |
461 | |
462 @defvar overwrite-mode | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
463 This variable controls whether overwrite mode is in effect. The value |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
464 should be @code{overwrite-mode-textual}, @code{overwrite-mode-binary}, |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
465 or @code{nil}. @code{overwrite-mode-textual} specifies textual |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
466 overwrite mode (treats newlines and tabs specially), and |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
467 @code{overwrite-mode-binary} specifies binary overwrite mode (treats |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
468 newlines and tabs like any other characters). |
6558 | 469 @end defvar |
470 | |
471 @node Deletion | |
12098 | 472 @section Deleting Text |
6558 | 473 |
474 @cindex deletion vs killing | |
475 Deletion means removing part of the text in a buffer, without saving | |
476 it in the kill ring (@pxref{The Kill Ring}). Deleted text can't be | |
477 yanked, but can be reinserted using the undo mechanism (@pxref{Undo}). | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
478 Some deletion functions do save text in the kill ring in some special |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
479 cases. |
6558 | 480 |
481 All of the deletion functions operate on the current buffer, and all | |
482 return a value of @code{nil}. | |
483 | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
484 @deffn Command erase-buffer |
6558 | 485 This function deletes the entire text of the current buffer, leaving it |
486 empty. If the buffer is read-only, it signals a @code{buffer-read-only} | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
487 error; if some of the text in it is read-only, it signals a |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
488 @code{text-read-only} error. Otherwise, it deletes the text without |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
489 asking for any confirmation. It returns @code{nil}. |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
490 |
6558 | 491 Normally, deleting a large amount of text from a buffer inhibits further |
492 auto-saving of that buffer ``because it has shrunk''. However, | |
493 @code{erase-buffer} does not do this, the idea being that the future | |
494 text is not really related to the former text, and its size should not | |
495 be compared with that of the former text. | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
496 @end deffn |
6558 | 497 |
498 @deffn Command delete-region start end | |
27654
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
499 This command deletes the text between positions @var{start} and |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
500 @var{end} in the current buffer, and returns @code{nil}. If point was |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
501 inside the deleted region, its value afterward is @var{start}. |
12775
a8cd9be43025
Explain how delete-region alters point.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
12282
diff
changeset
|
502 Otherwise, point relocates with the surrounding text, as markers do. |
6558 | 503 @end deffn |
504 | |
27654
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
505 @defun delete-and-extract-region start end |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
506 @tindex delete-and-extract-region |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
507 This function deletes the text between positions @var{start} and |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
508 @var{end} in the current buffer, and returns a string containing the |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
509 text just deleted. |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
510 |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
511 If point was inside the deleted region, its value afterward is |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
512 @var{start}. Otherwise, point relocates with the surrounding text, as |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
513 markers do. |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
514 @end defun |
cabb1b4c4424
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27374
diff
changeset
|
515 |
6558 | 516 @deffn Command delete-char count &optional killp |
517 This command deletes @var{count} characters directly after point, or | |
518 before point if @var{count} is negative. If @var{killp} is | |
519 non-@code{nil}, then it saves the deleted characters in the kill ring. | |
520 | |
521 In an interactive call, @var{count} is the numeric prefix argument, and | |
522 @var{killp} is the unprocessed prefix argument. Therefore, if a prefix | |
523 argument is supplied, the text is saved in the kill ring. If no prefix | |
524 argument is supplied, then one character is deleted, but not saved in | |
525 the kill ring. | |
526 | |
527 The value returned is always @code{nil}. | |
528 @end deffn | |
529 | |
530 @deffn Command delete-backward-char count &optional killp | |
531 @cindex delete previous char | |
532 This command deletes @var{count} characters directly before point, or | |
533 after point if @var{count} is negative. If @var{killp} is | |
534 non-@code{nil}, then it saves the deleted characters in the kill ring. | |
535 | |
536 In an interactive call, @var{count} is the numeric prefix argument, and | |
537 @var{killp} is the unprocessed prefix argument. Therefore, if a prefix | |
538 argument is supplied, the text is saved in the kill ring. If no prefix | |
539 argument is supplied, then one character is deleted, but not saved in | |
540 the kill ring. | |
541 | |
542 The value returned is always @code{nil}. | |
543 @end deffn | |
544 | |
545 @deffn Command backward-delete-char-untabify count &optional killp | |
546 @cindex tab deletion | |
547 This command deletes @var{count} characters backward, changing tabs | |
548 into spaces. When the next character to be deleted is a tab, it is | |
549 first replaced with the proper number of spaces to preserve alignment | |
550 and then one of those spaces is deleted instead of the tab. If | |
551 @var{killp} is non-@code{nil}, then the command saves the deleted | |
552 characters in the kill ring. | |
553 | |
554 Conversion of tabs to spaces happens only if @var{count} is positive. | |
555 If it is negative, exactly @minus{}@var{count} characters after point | |
556 are deleted. | |
557 | |
558 In an interactive call, @var{count} is the numeric prefix argument, and | |
559 @var{killp} is the unprocessed prefix argument. Therefore, if a prefix | |
560 argument is supplied, the text is saved in the kill ring. If no prefix | |
561 argument is supplied, then one character is deleted, but not saved in | |
562 the kill ring. | |
563 | |
564 The value returned is always @code{nil}. | |
565 @end deffn | |
566 | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
567 @defopt backward-delete-char-untabify-method |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
568 This option specifies how @code{backward-delete-char-untabify} should |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
569 deal with whitespace. Possible values include @code{untabify}, the |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
570 default, meaning convert a tab to many spaces and delete one; |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
571 @code{hungry}, meaning delete all the whitespace characters before point |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
572 with one command, and @code{nil}, meaning do nothing special for |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
573 whitespace characters. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
574 @end defopt |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
575 |
6558 | 576 @node User-Level Deletion |
577 @section User-Level Deletion Commands | |
578 | |
579 This section describes higher-level commands for deleting text, | |
580 commands intended primarily for the user but useful also in Lisp | |
581 programs. | |
582 | |
583 @deffn Command delete-horizontal-space | |
584 @cindex deleting whitespace | |
585 This function deletes all spaces and tabs around point. It returns | |
586 @code{nil}. | |
587 | |
588 In the following examples, we call @code{delete-horizontal-space} four | |
589 times, once on each line, with point between the second and third | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
590 characters on the line each time. |
6558 | 591 |
592 @example | |
593 @group | |
594 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
595 I @point{}thought | |
596 I @point{} thought | |
597 We@point{} thought | |
598 Yo@point{}u thought | |
599 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
600 @end group | |
601 | |
602 @group | |
603 (delete-horizontal-space) ; @r{Four times.} | |
604 @result{} nil | |
605 | |
606 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
607 Ithought | |
608 Ithought | |
609 Wethought | |
610 You thought | |
611 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
612 @end group | |
613 @end example | |
614 @end deffn | |
615 | |
616 @deffn Command delete-indentation &optional join-following-p | |
617 This function joins the line point is on to the previous line, deleting | |
618 any whitespace at the join and in some cases replacing it with one | |
619 space. If @var{join-following-p} is non-@code{nil}, | |
620 @code{delete-indentation} joins this line to the following line | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
621 instead. The function returns @code{nil}. |
6558 | 622 |
623 If there is a fill prefix, and the second of the lines being joined | |
624 starts with the prefix, then @code{delete-indentation} deletes the | |
12098 | 625 fill prefix before joining the lines. @xref{Margins}. |
6558 | 626 |
627 In the example below, point is located on the line starting | |
628 @samp{events}, and it makes no difference if there are trailing spaces | |
629 in the preceding line. | |
630 | |
631 @smallexample | |
7735
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
632 @group |
6558 | 633 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- |
634 When in the course of human | |
635 @point{} events, it becomes necessary | |
636 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
7735
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
637 @end group |
6558 | 638 |
639 (delete-indentation) | |
640 @result{} nil | |
641 | |
7735
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
642 @group |
6558 | 643 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- |
644 When in the course of human@point{} events, it becomes necessary | |
645 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
7735
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
646 @end group |
6558 | 647 @end smallexample |
648 | |
649 After the lines are joined, the function @code{fixup-whitespace} is | |
650 responsible for deciding whether to leave a space at the junction. | |
651 @end deffn | |
652 | |
653 @defun fixup-whitespace | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
654 This function replaces all the whitespace surrounding point with either |
6558 | 655 one space or no space, according to the context. It returns @code{nil}. |
656 | |
657 At the beginning or end of a line, the appropriate amount of space is | |
658 none. Before a character with close parenthesis syntax, or after a | |
659 character with open parenthesis or expression-prefix syntax, no space is | |
660 also appropriate. Otherwise, one space is appropriate. @xref{Syntax | |
661 Class Table}. | |
662 | |
663 In the example below, @code{fixup-whitespace} is called the first time | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
664 with point before the word @samp{spaces} in the first line. For the |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
665 second invocation, point is directly after the @samp{(}. |
6558 | 666 |
667 @smallexample | |
668 @group | |
669 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
670 This has too many @point{}spaces | |
671 This has too many spaces at the start of (@point{} this list) | |
672 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
673 @end group | |
674 | |
675 @group | |
676 (fixup-whitespace) | |
677 @result{} nil | |
678 (fixup-whitespace) | |
679 @result{} nil | |
680 @end group | |
681 | |
682 @group | |
683 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
684 This has too many spaces | |
685 This has too many spaces at the start of (this list) | |
686 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
687 @end group | |
688 @end smallexample | |
689 @end defun | |
690 | |
691 @deffn Command just-one-space | |
692 @comment !!SourceFile simple.el | |
693 This command replaces any spaces and tabs around point with a single | |
694 space. It returns @code{nil}. | |
695 @end deffn | |
696 | |
697 @deffn Command delete-blank-lines | |
698 This function deletes blank lines surrounding point. If point is on a | |
699 blank line with one or more blank lines before or after it, then all but | |
700 one of them are deleted. If point is on an isolated blank line, then it | |
701 is deleted. If point is on a nonblank line, the command deletes all | |
702 blank lines following it. | |
703 | |
704 A blank line is defined as a line containing only tabs and spaces. | |
705 | |
706 @code{delete-blank-lines} returns @code{nil}. | |
707 @end deffn | |
708 | |
709 @node The Kill Ring | |
710 @section The Kill Ring | |
711 @cindex kill ring | |
712 | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
713 @dfn{Kill functions} delete text like the deletion functions, but save |
6558 | 714 it so that the user can reinsert it by @dfn{yanking}. Most of these |
715 functions have @samp{kill-} in their name. By contrast, the functions | |
716 whose names start with @samp{delete-} normally do not save text for | |
717 yanking (though they can still be undone); these are ``deletion'' | |
718 functions. | |
719 | |
720 Most of the kill commands are primarily for interactive use, and are | |
721 not described here. What we do describe are the functions provided for | |
722 use in writing such commands. You can use these functions to write | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
723 commands for killing text. When you need to delete text for internal |
6558 | 724 purposes within a Lisp function, you should normally use deletion |
725 functions, so as not to disturb the kill ring contents. | |
726 @xref{Deletion}. | |
727 | |
728 Killed text is saved for later yanking in the @dfn{kill ring}. This | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
729 is a list that holds a number of recent kills, not just the last text |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
730 kill. We call this a ``ring'' because yanking treats it as having |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
731 elements in a cyclic order. The list is kept in the variable |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
732 @code{kill-ring}, and can be operated on with the usual functions for |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
733 lists; there are also specialized functions, described in this section, |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
734 that treat it as a ring. |
6558 | 735 |
736 Some people think this use of the word ``kill'' is unfortunate, since | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
737 it refers to operations that specifically @emph{do not} destroy the |
6558 | 738 entities ``killed''. This is in sharp contrast to ordinary life, in |
739 which death is permanent and ``killed'' entities do not come back to | |
740 life. Therefore, other metaphors have been proposed. For example, the | |
741 term ``cut ring'' makes sense to people who, in pre-computer days, used | |
742 scissors and paste to cut up and rearrange manuscripts. However, it | |
743 would be difficult to change the terminology now. | |
744 | |
745 @menu | |
746 * Kill Ring Concepts:: What text looks like in the kill ring. | |
747 * Kill Functions:: Functions that kill text. | |
748 * Yank Commands:: Commands that access the kill ring. | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
749 * Low-Level Kill Ring:: Functions and variables for kill ring access. |
6558 | 750 * Internals of Kill Ring:: Variables that hold kill-ring data. |
751 @end menu | |
752 | |
753 @node Kill Ring Concepts | |
754 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
755 @subsection Kill Ring Concepts | |
756 | |
757 The kill ring records killed text as strings in a list, most recent | |
758 first. A short kill ring, for example, might look like this: | |
759 | |
760 @example | |
761 ("some text" "a different piece of text" "even older text") | |
762 @end example | |
763 | |
764 @noindent | |
765 When the list reaches @code{kill-ring-max} entries in length, adding a | |
766 new entry automatically deletes the last entry. | |
767 | |
768 When kill commands are interwoven with other commands, each kill | |
769 command makes a new entry in the kill ring. Multiple kill commands in | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
770 succession build up a single kill-ring entry, which would be yanked as a |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
771 unit; the second and subsequent consecutive kill commands add text to |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
772 the entry made by the first one. |
6558 | 773 |
774 For yanking, one entry in the kill ring is designated the ``front'' of | |
775 the ring. Some yank commands ``rotate'' the ring by designating a | |
776 different element as the ``front.'' But this virtual rotation doesn't | |
777 change the list itself---the most recent entry always comes first in the | |
778 list. | |
779 | |
780 @node Kill Functions | |
781 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
782 @subsection Functions for Killing | |
783 | |
784 @code{kill-region} is the usual subroutine for killing text. Any | |
785 command that calls this function is a ``kill command'' (and should | |
786 probably have @samp{kill} in its name). @code{kill-region} puts the | |
787 newly killed text in a new element at the beginning of the kill ring or | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
788 adds it to the most recent element. It determines automatically (using |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
789 @code{last-command}) whether the previous command was a kill command, |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
790 and if so appends the killed text to the most recent entry. |
6558 | 791 |
792 @deffn Command kill-region start end | |
793 This function kills the text in the region defined by @var{start} and | |
12098 | 794 @var{end}. The text is deleted but saved in the kill ring, along with |
795 its text properties. The value is always @code{nil}. | |
6558 | 796 |
797 In an interactive call, @var{start} and @var{end} are point and | |
798 the mark. | |
799 | |
800 @c Emacs 19 feature | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
801 If the buffer or text is read-only, @code{kill-region} modifies the kill |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
802 ring just the same, then signals an error without modifying the buffer. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
803 This is convenient because it lets the user use a series of kill |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
804 commands to copy text from a read-only buffer into the kill ring. |
6558 | 805 @end deffn |
806 | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
807 @defopt kill-read-only-ok |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
808 If this option is non-@code{nil}, @code{kill-region} does not signal an |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
809 error if the buffer or text is read-only. Instead, it simply returns, |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
810 updating the kill ring but not changing the buffer. |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
811 @end defopt |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
812 |
6558 | 813 @deffn Command copy-region-as-kill start end |
814 This command saves the region defined by @var{start} and @var{end} on | |
12098 | 815 the kill ring (including text properties), but does not delete the text |
816 from the buffer. It returns @code{nil}. It also indicates the extent | |
817 of the text copied by moving the cursor momentarily, or by displaying a | |
818 message in the echo area. | |
6558 | 819 |
12067 | 820 The command does not set @code{this-command} to @code{kill-region}, so a |
821 subsequent kill command does not append to the same kill ring entry. | |
822 | |
6558 | 823 Don't call @code{copy-region-as-kill} in Lisp programs unless you aim to |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
824 support Emacs 18. For newer Emacs versions, it is better to use |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
825 @code{kill-new} or @code{kill-append} instead. @xref{Low-Level Kill |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
826 Ring}. |
6558 | 827 @end deffn |
828 | |
829 @node Yank Commands | |
830 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
831 @subsection Functions for Yanking | |
832 | |
833 @dfn{Yanking} means reinserting an entry of previously killed text | |
12098 | 834 from the kill ring. The text properties are copied too. |
6558 | 835 |
836 @deffn Command yank &optional arg | |
837 @cindex inserting killed text | |
838 This command inserts before point the text in the first entry in the | |
839 kill ring. It positions the mark at the beginning of that text, and | |
840 point at the end. | |
841 | |
842 If @var{arg} is a list (which occurs interactively when the user | |
843 types @kbd{C-u} with no digits), then @code{yank} inserts the text as | |
844 described above, but puts point before the yanked text and puts the mark | |
845 after it. | |
846 | |
847 If @var{arg} is a number, then @code{yank} inserts the @var{arg}th most | |
848 recently killed text---the @var{arg}th element of the kill ring list. | |
849 | |
850 @code{yank} does not alter the contents of the kill ring or rotate it. | |
851 It returns @code{nil}. | |
852 @end deffn | |
853 | |
854 @deffn Command yank-pop arg | |
855 This command replaces the just-yanked entry from the kill ring with a | |
856 different entry from the kill ring. | |
857 | |
858 This is allowed only immediately after a @code{yank} or another | |
859 @code{yank-pop}. At such a time, the region contains text that was just | |
860 inserted by yanking. @code{yank-pop} deletes that text and inserts in | |
861 its place a different piece of killed text. It does not add the deleted | |
862 text to the kill ring, since it is already in the kill ring somewhere. | |
863 | |
864 If @var{arg} is @code{nil}, then the replacement text is the previous | |
865 element of the kill ring. If @var{arg} is numeric, the replacement is | |
866 the @var{arg}th previous kill. If @var{arg} is negative, a more recent | |
867 kill is the replacement. | |
868 | |
869 The sequence of kills in the kill ring wraps around, so that after the | |
870 oldest one comes the newest one, and before the newest one goes the | |
871 oldest. | |
872 | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
873 The return value is always @code{nil}. |
6558 | 874 @end deffn |
875 | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
876 @node Low-Level Kill Ring |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
877 @subsection Low-Level Kill Ring |
6558 | 878 |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
879 These functions and variables provide access to the kill ring at a |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
880 lower level, but still convenient for use in Lisp programs, because they |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
881 take care of interaction with window system selections |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
882 (@pxref{Window System Selections}). |
6558 | 883 |
884 @defun current-kill n &optional do-not-move | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
885 The function @code{current-kill} rotates the yanking pointer, which |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
886 designates the ``front'' of the kill ring, by @var{n} places (from newer |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
887 kills to older ones), and returns the text at that place in the ring. |
6558 | 888 |
889 If the optional second argument @var{do-not-move} is non-@code{nil}, | |
890 then @code{current-kill} doesn't alter the yanking pointer; it just | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
891 returns the @var{n}th kill, counting from the current yanking pointer. |
6558 | 892 |
893 If @var{n} is zero, indicating a request for the latest kill, | |
894 @code{current-kill} calls the value of | |
895 @code{interprogram-paste-function} (documented below) before consulting | |
896 the kill ring. | |
897 @end defun | |
898 | |
899 @defun kill-new string | |
900 This function puts the text @var{string} into the kill ring as a new | |
901 entry at the front of the ring. It discards the oldest entry if | |
902 appropriate. It also invokes the value of | |
903 @code{interprogram-cut-function} (see below). | |
904 @end defun | |
905 | |
906 @defun kill-append string before-p | |
907 This function appends the text @var{string} to the first entry in the | |
908 kill ring. Normally @var{string} goes at the end of the entry, but if | |
909 @var{before-p} is non-@code{nil}, it goes at the beginning. This | |
910 function also invokes the value of @code{interprogram-cut-function} (see | |
911 below). | |
912 @end defun | |
913 | |
914 @defvar interprogram-paste-function | |
915 This variable provides a way of transferring killed text from other | |
916 programs, when you are using a window system. Its value should be | |
917 @code{nil} or a function of no arguments. | |
918 | |
919 If the value is a function, @code{current-kill} calls it to get the | |
920 ``most recent kill''. If the function returns a non-@code{nil} value, | |
921 then that value is used as the ``most recent kill''. If it returns | |
922 @code{nil}, then the first element of @code{kill-ring} is used. | |
923 | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
924 The normal use of this hook is to get the window system's primary |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
925 selection as the most recent kill, even if the selection belongs to |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
926 another application. @xref{Window System Selections}. |
6558 | 927 @end defvar |
928 | |
929 @defvar interprogram-cut-function | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
930 This variable provides a way of communicating killed text to other |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
931 programs, when you are using a window system. Its value should be |
6558 | 932 @code{nil} or a function of one argument. |
933 | |
934 If the value is a function, @code{kill-new} and @code{kill-append} call | |
935 it with the new first element of the kill ring as an argument. | |
936 | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
937 The normal use of this hook is to set the window system's primary |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
938 selection from the newly killed text. @xref{Window System Selections}. |
6558 | 939 @end defvar |
940 | |
941 @node Internals of Kill Ring | |
942 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
943 @subsection Internals of the Kill Ring | |
944 | |
945 The variable @code{kill-ring} holds the kill ring contents, in the | |
946 form of a list of strings. The most recent kill is always at the front | |
947 of the list. | |
948 | |
949 The @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} variable points to a link in the | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
950 kill ring list, whose @sc{car} is the text to yank next. We say it |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
951 identifies the ``front'' of the ring. Moving |
6558 | 952 @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} to a different link is called |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
953 @dfn{rotating the kill ring}. We call the kill ring a ``ring'' because |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
954 the functions that move the yank pointer wrap around from the end of the |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
955 list to the beginning, or vice-versa. Rotation of the kill ring is |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
956 virtual; it does not change the value of @code{kill-ring}. |
6558 | 957 |
958 Both @code{kill-ring} and @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} are Lisp | |
959 variables whose values are normally lists. The word ``pointer'' in the | |
960 name of the @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} indicates that the variable's | |
961 purpose is to identify one element of the list for use by the next yank | |
962 command. | |
963 | |
964 The value of @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} is always @code{eq} to one | |
965 of the links in the kill ring list. The element it identifies is the | |
966 @sc{car} of that link. Kill commands, which change the kill ring, also | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
967 set this variable to the value of @code{kill-ring}. The effect is to |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
968 rotate the ring so that the newly killed text is at the front. |
6558 | 969 |
970 Here is a diagram that shows the variable @code{kill-ring-yank-pointer} | |
971 pointing to the second entry in the kill ring @code{("some text" "a | |
972 different piece of text" "yet older text")}. | |
973 | |
974 @example | |
975 @group | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
976 kill-ring ---- kill-ring-yank-pointer |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
977 | | |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
978 | v |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
979 | --- --- --- --- --- --- |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
980 --> | | |------> | | |--> | | |--> nil |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
981 --- --- --- --- --- --- |
6558 | 982 | | | |
983 | | | | |
984 | | -->"yet older text" | |
985 | | | |
986 | --> "a different piece of text" | |
987 | | |
988 --> "some text" | |
989 @end group | |
990 @end example | |
991 | |
992 @noindent | |
993 This state of affairs might occur after @kbd{C-y} (@code{yank}) | |
994 immediately followed by @kbd{M-y} (@code{yank-pop}). | |
995 | |
996 @defvar kill-ring | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
997 This variable holds the list of killed text sequences, most recently |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
998 killed first. |
6558 | 999 @end defvar |
1000 | |
1001 @defvar kill-ring-yank-pointer | |
1002 This variable's value indicates which element of the kill ring is at the | |
1003 ``front'' of the ring for yanking. More precisely, the value is a tail | |
1004 of the value of @code{kill-ring}, and its @sc{car} is the kill string | |
1005 that @kbd{C-y} should yank. | |
1006 @end defvar | |
1007 | |
1008 @defopt kill-ring-max | |
1009 The value of this variable is the maximum length to which the kill | |
1010 ring can grow, before elements are thrown away at the end. The default | |
1011 value for @code{kill-ring-max} is 30. | |
1012 @end defopt | |
1013 | |
1014 @node Undo | |
1015 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
1016 @section Undo | |
1017 @cindex redo | |
1018 | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1019 Most buffers have an @dfn{undo list}, which records all changes made |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1020 to the buffer's text so that they can be undone. (The buffers that |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1021 don't have one are usually special-purpose buffers for which Emacs |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1022 assumes that undoing is not useful.) All the primitives that modify the |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1023 text in the buffer automatically add elements to the front of the undo |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1024 list, which is in the variable @code{buffer-undo-list}. |
6558 | 1025 |
1026 @defvar buffer-undo-list | |
1027 This variable's value is the undo list of the current buffer. | |
1028 A value of @code{t} disables the recording of undo information. | |
1029 @end defvar | |
1030 | |
1031 Here are the kinds of elements an undo list can have: | |
1032 | |
1033 @table @code | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1034 @item @var{position} |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1035 This kind of element records a previous value of point; undoing this |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1036 element moves point to @var{position}. Ordinary cursor motion does not |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1037 make any sort of undo record, but deletion operations use these entries |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1038 to record where point was before the command. |
6558 | 1039 |
1040 @item (@var{beg} . @var{end}) | |
1041 This kind of element indicates how to delete text that was inserted. | |
1042 Upon insertion, the text occupied the range @var{beg}--@var{end} in the | |
1043 buffer. | |
1044 | |
10364 | 1045 @item (@var{text} . @var{position}) |
6558 | 1046 This kind of element indicates how to reinsert text that was deleted. |
10364 | 1047 The deleted text itself is the string @var{text}. The place to |
1048 reinsert it is @code{(abs @var{position})}. | |
6558 | 1049 |
1050 @item (t @var{high} . @var{low}) | |
1051 This kind of element indicates that an unmodified buffer became | |
1052 modified. The elements @var{high} and @var{low} are two integers, each | |
1053 recording 16 bits of the visited file's modification time as of when it | |
1054 was previously visited or saved. @code{primitive-undo} uses those | |
1055 values to determine whether to mark the buffer as unmodified once again; | |
1056 it does so only if the file's modification time matches those numbers. | |
1057 | |
1058 @item (nil @var{property} @var{value} @var{beg} . @var{end}) | |
1059 This kind of element records a change in a text property. | |
1060 Here's how you might undo the change: | |
1061 | |
1062 @example | |
1063 (put-text-property @var{beg} @var{end} @var{property} @var{value}) | |
1064 @end example | |
1065 | |
15760
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
1066 @item (@var{marker} . @var{adjustment}) |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
1067 This kind of element records the fact that the marker @var{marker} was |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
1068 relocated due to deletion of surrounding text, and that it moved |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
1069 @var{adjustment} character positions. Undoing this element moves |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
1070 @var{marker} @minus{} @var{adjustment} characters. |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
1071 |
6558 | 1072 @item nil |
1073 This element is a boundary. The elements between two boundaries are | |
1074 called a @dfn{change group}; normally, each change group corresponds to | |
1075 one keyboard command, and undo commands normally undo an entire group as | |
1076 a unit. | |
1077 @end table | |
1078 | |
1079 @defun undo-boundary | |
1080 This function places a boundary element in the undo list. The undo | |
1081 command stops at such a boundary, and successive undo commands undo | |
1082 to earlier and earlier boundaries. This function returns @code{nil}. | |
1083 | |
11555
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1084 The editor command loop automatically creates an undo boundary before |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1085 each key sequence is executed. Thus, each undo normally undoes the |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1086 effects of one command. Self-inserting input characters are an |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1087 exception. The command loop makes a boundary for the first such |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1088 character; the next 19 consecutive self-inserting input characters do |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1089 not make boundaries, and then the 20th does, and so on as long as |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1090 self-inserting characters continue. |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1091 |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1092 All buffer modifications add a boundary whenever the previous undoable |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1093 change was made in some other buffer. This is to ensure that |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1094 each command makes a boundary in each buffer where it makes changes. |
11555
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1095 |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1096 Calling this function explicitly is useful for splitting the effects of |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1097 a command into more than one unit. For example, @code{query-replace} |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1098 calls @code{undo-boundary} after each replacement, so that the user can |
4cc0a5e1bdac
Explan when boundaries are made automatically.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
10364
diff
changeset
|
1099 undo individual replacements one by one. |
6558 | 1100 @end defun |
1101 | |
1102 @defun primitive-undo count list | |
1103 This is the basic function for undoing elements of an undo list. | |
1104 It undoes the first @var{count} elements of @var{list}, returning | |
1105 the rest of @var{list}. You could write this function in Lisp, | |
1106 but it is convenient to have it in C. | |
1107 | |
1108 @code{primitive-undo} adds elements to the buffer's undo list when it | |
1109 changes the buffer. Undo commands avoid confusion by saving the undo | |
1110 list value at the beginning of a sequence of undo operations. Then the | |
1111 undo operations use and update the saved value. The new elements added | |
12098 | 1112 by undoing are not part of this saved value, so they don't interfere with |
6558 | 1113 continuing to undo. |
1114 @end defun | |
1115 | |
1116 @node Maintaining Undo | |
1117 @section Maintaining Undo Lists | |
1118 | |
1119 This section describes how to enable and disable undo information for | |
1120 a given buffer. It also explains how the undo list is truncated | |
1121 automatically so it doesn't get too big. | |
1122 | |
1123 Recording of undo information in a newly created buffer is normally | |
1124 enabled to start with; but if the buffer name starts with a space, the | |
1125 undo recording is initially disabled. You can explicitly enable or | |
1126 disable undo recording with the following two functions, or by setting | |
1127 @code{buffer-undo-list} yourself. | |
1128 | |
1129 @deffn Command buffer-enable-undo &optional buffer-or-name | |
1130 This command enables recording undo information for buffer | |
1131 @var{buffer-or-name}, so that subsequent changes can be undone. If no | |
1132 argument is supplied, then the current buffer is used. This function | |
1133 does nothing if undo recording is already enabled in the buffer. It | |
1134 returns @code{nil}. | |
1135 | |
1136 In an interactive call, @var{buffer-or-name} is the current buffer. | |
1137 You cannot specify any other buffer. | |
1138 @end deffn | |
1139 | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1140 @deffn Command buffer-disable-undo &optional buffer |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1141 @deffnx Command buffer-flush-undo &optional buffer |
6558 | 1142 @cindex disable undo |
1143 This function discards the undo list of @var{buffer}, and disables | |
1144 further recording of undo information. As a result, it is no longer | |
1145 possible to undo either previous changes or any subsequent changes. If | |
1146 the undo list of @var{buffer} is already disabled, this function | |
1147 has no effect. | |
1148 | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1149 This function returns @code{nil}. |
6558 | 1150 |
1151 The name @code{buffer-flush-undo} is not considered obsolete, but the | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1152 preferred name is @code{buffer-disable-undo}. |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1153 @end deffn |
6558 | 1154 |
1155 As editing continues, undo lists get longer and longer. To prevent | |
1156 them from using up all available memory space, garbage collection trims | |
1157 them back to size limits you can set. (For this purpose, the ``size'' | |
1158 of an undo list measures the cons cells that make up the list, plus the | |
1159 strings of deleted text.) Two variables control the range of acceptable | |
1160 sizes: @code{undo-limit} and @code{undo-strong-limit}. | |
1161 | |
1162 @defvar undo-limit | |
1163 This is the soft limit for the acceptable size of an undo list. The | |
1164 change group at which this size is exceeded is the last one kept. | |
1165 @end defvar | |
1166 | |
1167 @defvar undo-strong-limit | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1168 This is the upper limit for the acceptable size of an undo list. The |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1169 change group at which this size is exceeded is discarded itself (along |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1170 with all older change groups). There is one exception: the very latest |
12282
586e3ea81792
updates for version 19.29 made by melissa; also needed to check out files
Melissa Weisshaus <melissa@gnu.org>
parents:
12098
diff
changeset
|
1171 change group is never discarded no matter how big it is. |
6558 | 1172 @end defvar |
1173 | |
1174 @node Filling | |
1175 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
1176 @section Filling | |
1177 @cindex filling, explicit | |
1178 | |
1179 @dfn{Filling} means adjusting the lengths of lines (by moving the line | |
1180 breaks) so that they are nearly (but no greater than) a specified | |
1181 maximum width. Additionally, lines can be @dfn{justified}, which means | |
12098 | 1182 inserting spaces to make the left and/or right margins line up |
1183 precisely. The width is controlled by the variable @code{fill-column}. | |
1184 For ease of reading, lines should be no longer than 70 or so columns. | |
6558 | 1185 |
1186 You can use Auto Fill mode (@pxref{Auto Filling}) to fill text | |
1187 automatically as you insert it, but changes to existing text may leave | |
1188 it improperly filled. Then you must fill the text explicitly. | |
1189 | |
12067 | 1190 Most of the commands in this section return values that are not |
1191 meaningful. All the functions that do filling take note of the current | |
12098 | 1192 left margin, current right margin, and current justification style |
1193 (@pxref{Margins}). If the current justification style is | |
1194 @code{none}, the filling functions don't actually do anything. | |
1195 | |
1196 Several of the filling functions have an argument @var{justify}. | |
1197 If it is non-@code{nil}, that requests some kind of justification. It | |
1198 can be @code{left}, @code{right}, @code{full}, or @code{center}, to | |
1199 request a specific style of justification. If it is @code{t}, that | |
1200 means to use the current justification style for this part of the text | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1201 (see @code{current-justification}, below). Any other value is treated |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1202 as @code{full}. |
12098 | 1203 |
1204 When you call the filling functions interactively, using a prefix | |
1205 argument implies the value @code{full} for @var{justify}. | |
1206 | |
1207 @deffn Command fill-paragraph justify | |
6558 | 1208 @cindex filling a paragraph |
1209 This command fills the paragraph at or after point. If | |
12098 | 1210 @var{justify} is non-@code{nil}, each line is justified as well. |
6558 | 1211 It uses the ordinary paragraph motion commands to find paragraph |
1212 boundaries. @xref{Paragraphs,,, emacs, The Emacs Manual}. | |
1213 @end deffn | |
1214 | |
25454 | 1215 @deffn Command fill-region start end &optional justify nosqueeze to-eop |
6558 | 1216 This command fills each of the paragraphs in the region from @var{start} |
12098 | 1217 to @var{end}. It justifies as well if @var{justify} is |
6558 | 1218 non-@code{nil}. |
1219 | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1220 If @var{nosqueeze} is non-@code{nil}, that means to leave whitespace |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1221 other than line breaks untouched. If @var{to-eop} is non-@code{nil}, |
22267
dfac7398266b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
1222 that means to keep filling to the end of the paragraph---or the next hard |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1223 newline, if @code{use-hard-newlines} is enabled (see below). |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1224 |
6558 | 1225 The variable @code{paragraph-separate} controls how to distinguish |
1226 paragraphs. @xref{Standard Regexps}. | |
1227 @end deffn | |
1228 | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1229 @deffn Command fill-individual-paragraphs start end &optional justify citation-regexp |
6558 | 1230 This command fills each paragraph in the region according to its |
1231 individual fill prefix. Thus, if the lines of a paragraph were indented | |
1232 with spaces, the filled paragraph will remain indented in the same | |
1233 fashion. | |
1234 | |
1235 The first two arguments, @var{start} and @var{end}, are the beginning | |
1236 and end of the region to be filled. The third and fourth arguments, | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1237 @var{justify} and @var{citation-regexp}, are optional. If |
12098 | 1238 @var{justify} is non-@code{nil}, the paragraphs are justified as |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1239 well as filled. If @var{citation-regexp} is non-@code{nil}, it means the |
6558 | 1240 function is operating on a mail message and therefore should not fill |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1241 the header lines. If @var{citation-regexp} is a string, it is used as |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1242 a regular expression; if it matches the beginning of a line, that line |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1243 is treated as a citation marker. |
6558 | 1244 |
1245 Ordinarily, @code{fill-individual-paragraphs} regards each change in | |
1246 indentation as starting a new paragraph. If | |
1247 @code{fill-individual-varying-indent} is non-@code{nil}, then only | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1248 separator lines separate paragraphs. That mode can handle indented |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1249 paragraphs with additional indentation on the first line. |
6558 | 1250 @end deffn |
1251 | |
1252 @defopt fill-individual-varying-indent | |
1253 This variable alters the action of @code{fill-individual-paragraphs} as | |
1254 described above. | |
1255 @end defopt | |
1256 | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1257 @deffn Command fill-region-as-paragraph start end &optional justify nosqueeze squeeze-after |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1258 This command considers a region of text as a single paragraph and fills |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1259 it. If the region was made up of many paragraphs, the blank lines |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1260 between paragraphs are removed. This function justifies as well as |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1261 filling when @var{justify} is non-@code{nil}. |
12067 | 1262 |
1263 In an interactive call, any prefix argument requests justification. | |
6558 | 1264 |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1265 If @var{nosqueeze} is non-@code{nil}, that means to leave whitespace |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1266 other than line breaks untouched. If @var{squeeze-after} is |
22267
dfac7398266b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
1267 non-@code{nil}, it specifies a position in the region, and means don't |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1268 canonicalize spaces before that position. |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1269 |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1270 In Adaptive Fill mode, this command calls @code{fill-context-prefix} to |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1271 choose a fill prefix by default. @xref{Adaptive Fill}. |
6558 | 1272 @end deffn |
1273 | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1274 @deffn Command justify-current-line &optional how eop nosqueeze |
6558 | 1275 This command inserts spaces between the words of the current line so |
1276 that the line ends exactly at @code{fill-column}. It returns | |
1277 @code{nil}. | |
12067 | 1278 |
1279 The argument @var{how}, if non-@code{nil} specifies explicitly the style | |
1280 of justification. It can be @code{left}, @code{right}, @code{full}, | |
1281 @code{center}, or @code{none}. If it is @code{t}, that means to do | |
1282 follow specified justification style (see @code{current-justification}, | |
1283 below). @code{nil} means to do full justification. | |
1284 | |
16736
981e116b4ac6
Minor cleanups for overfull hboxes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16702
diff
changeset
|
1285 If @var{eop} is non-@code{nil}, that means do left-justification if |
12067 | 1286 @code{current-justification} specifies full justification. This is used |
1287 for the last line of a paragraph; even if the paragraph as a whole is | |
1288 fully justified, the last line should not be. | |
1289 | |
1290 If @var{nosqueeze} is non-@code{nil}, that means do not change interior | |
1291 whitespace. | |
6558 | 1292 @end deffn |
1293 | |
12067 | 1294 @defopt default-justification |
1295 This variable's value specifies the style of justification to use for | |
1296 text that doesn't specify a style with a text property. The possible | |
1297 values are @code{left}, @code{right}, @code{full}, @code{center}, or | |
12098 | 1298 @code{none}. The default value is @code{left}. |
12067 | 1299 @end defopt |
1300 | |
1301 @defun current-justification | |
1302 This function returns the proper justification style to use for filling | |
1303 the text around point. | |
1304 @end defun | |
1305 | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1306 @defopt sentence-end-double-space |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1307 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, a period followed by just one space |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1308 does not count as the end of a sentence, and the filling functions |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1309 avoid breaking the line at such a place. |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1310 @end defopt |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1311 |
12098 | 1312 @defvar fill-paragraph-function |
1313 This variable provides a way for major modes to override the filling of | |
1314 paragraphs. If the value is non-@code{nil}, @code{fill-paragraph} calls | |
1315 this function to do the work. If the function returns a non-@code{nil} | |
1316 value, @code{fill-paragraph} assumes the job is done, and immediately | |
1317 returns that value. | |
1318 | |
1319 The usual use of this feature is to fill comments in programming | |
1320 language modes. If the function needs to fill a paragraph in the usual | |
1321 way, it can do so as follows: | |
1322 | |
1323 @example | |
1324 (let ((fill-paragraph-function nil)) | |
1325 (fill-paragraph arg)) | |
1326 @end example | |
1327 @end defvar | |
1328 | |
1329 @defvar use-hard-newlines | |
1330 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, the filling functions do not delete | |
1331 newlines that have the @code{hard} text property. These ``hard | |
1332 newlines'' act as paragraph separators. | |
1333 @end defvar | |
1334 | |
1335 @node Margins | |
1336 @section Margins for Filling | |
1337 | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1338 @defopt fill-prefix |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1339 This buffer-local variable specifies a string of text that appears at |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1340 the beginning |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1341 of normal text lines and should be disregarded when filling them. Any |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1342 line that fails to start with the fill prefix is considered the start of |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1343 a paragraph; so is any line that starts with the fill prefix followed by |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1344 additional whitespace. Lines that start with the fill prefix but no |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1345 additional whitespace are ordinary text lines that can be filled |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1346 together. The resulting filled lines also start with the fill prefix. |
12098 | 1347 |
1348 The fill prefix follows the left margin whitespace, if any. | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1349 @end defopt |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1350 |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1351 @defopt fill-column |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1352 This buffer-local variable specifies the maximum width of filled lines. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1353 Its value should be an integer, which is a number of columns. All the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1354 filling, justification, and centering commands are affected by this |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1355 variable, including Auto Fill mode (@pxref{Auto Filling}). |
6558 | 1356 |
1357 As a practical matter, if you are writing text for other people to | |
1358 read, you should set @code{fill-column} to no more than 70. Otherwise | |
1359 the line will be too long for people to read comfortably, and this can | |
1360 make the text seem clumsy. | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1361 @end defopt |
6558 | 1362 |
1363 @defvar default-fill-column | |
1364 The value of this variable is the default value for @code{fill-column} in | |
1365 buffers that do not override it. This is the same as | |
1366 @code{(default-value 'fill-column)}. | |
1367 | |
1368 The default value for @code{default-fill-column} is 70. | |
1369 @end defvar | |
1370 | |
12067 | 1371 @deffn Command set-left-margin from to margin |
1372 This sets the @code{left-margin} property on the text from @var{from} to | |
1373 @var{to} to the value @var{margin}. If Auto Fill mode is enabled, this | |
1374 command also refills the region to fit the new margin. | |
1375 @end deffn | |
1376 | |
1377 @deffn Command set-right-margin from to margin | |
12098 | 1378 This sets the @code{right-margin} property on the text from @var{from} |
1379 to @var{to} to the value @var{margin}. If Auto Fill mode is enabled, | |
1380 this command also refills the region to fit the new margin. | |
12067 | 1381 @end deffn |
1382 | |
1383 @defun current-left-margin | |
1384 This function returns the proper left margin value to use for filling | |
1385 the text around point. The value is the sum of the @code{left-margin} | |
1386 property of the character at the start of the current line (or zero if | |
12098 | 1387 none), and the value of the variable @code{left-margin}. |
12067 | 1388 @end defun |
1389 | |
1390 @defun current-fill-column | |
1391 This function returns the proper fill column value to use for filling | |
1392 the text around point. The value is the value of the @code{fill-column} | |
1393 variable, minus the value of the @code{right-margin} property of the | |
1394 character after point. | |
1395 @end defun | |
1396 | |
1397 @deffn Command move-to-left-margin &optional n force | |
1398 This function moves point to the left margin of the current line. The | |
1399 column moved to is determined by calling the function | |
12098 | 1400 @code{current-left-margin}. If the argument @var{n} is non-@code{nil}, |
12067 | 1401 @code{move-to-left-margin} moves forward @var{n}@minus{}1 lines first. |
1402 | |
1403 If @var{force} is non-@code{nil}, that says to fix the line's | |
1404 indentation if that doesn't match the left margin value. | |
1405 @end deffn | |
1406 | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1407 @defun delete-to-left-margin &optional from to |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1408 This function removes left margin indentation from the text between |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1409 @var{from} and @var{to}. The amount of indentation to delete is |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1410 determined by calling @code{current-left-margin}. In no case does this |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1411 function delete non-whitespace. If @var{from} and @var{to} are omitted, |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1412 they default to the whole buffer. |
12067 | 1413 @end defun |
1414 | |
12098 | 1415 @defun indent-to-left-margin |
1416 This is the default @code{indent-line-function}, used in Fundamental | |
1417 mode, Text mode, etc. Its effect is to adjust the indentation at the | |
1418 beginning of the current line to the value specified by the variable | |
1419 @code{left-margin}. This may involve either inserting or deleting | |
1420 whitespace. | |
1421 @end defun | |
1422 | |
1423 @defvar left-margin | |
1424 This variable specifies the base left margin column. In Fundamental | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1425 mode, @kbd{C-j} indents to this column. This variable automatically |
12098 | 1426 becomes buffer-local when set in any fashion. |
1427 @end defvar | |
1428 | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1429 @defvar fill-nobreak-predicate |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1430 This variable gives major modes a way to specify not to break a line at |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1431 certain places. Its value should be a function. This function is |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1432 called during filling, with no arguments and with point located at the |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1433 place where a break is being considered. If the function returns |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1434 non-@code{nil}, then the line won't be broken there. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1435 @end defvar |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1436 |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1437 @node Adaptive Fill |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1438 @section Adaptive Fill Mode |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1439 @cindex Adaptive Fill mode |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1440 |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1441 Adaptive Fill mode chooses a fill prefix automatically from the text |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1442 in each paragraph being filled. |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1443 |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1444 @defopt adaptive-fill-mode |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1445 Adaptive Fill mode is enabled when this variable is non-@code{nil}. |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1446 It is @code{t} by default. |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1447 @end defopt |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1448 |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1449 @defun fill-context-prefix from to |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1450 This function implements the heart of Adaptive Fill mode; it chooses a |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1451 fill prefix based on the text between @var{from} and @var{to}. It does |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1452 this by looking at the first two lines of the paragraph, based on the |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1453 variables described below. |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1454 @c The optional argument first-line-regexp is not documented |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1455 @c because it exists for internal purposes and might be eliminated |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
1456 @c in the future. |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1457 @end defun |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1458 |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1459 @defopt adaptive-fill-regexp |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1460 This variable holds a regular expression to control Adaptive Fill mode. |
22267
dfac7398266b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
1461 Adaptive Fill mode matches this regular expression against the text |
dfac7398266b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
1462 starting after the left margin whitespace (if any) on a line; the |
dfac7398266b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
1463 characters it matches are that line's candidate for the fill prefix. |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1464 @end defopt |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1465 |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1466 @defopt adaptive-fill-first-line-regexp |
22267
dfac7398266b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
1467 In a one-line paragraph, if the candidate fill prefix matches this |
dfac7398266b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
1468 regular expression, or if it matches @code{comment-start-skip}, then it |
dfac7398266b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
1469 is used---otherwise, spaces amounting to the same width are used |
dfac7398266b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22252
diff
changeset
|
1470 instead. |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1471 |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1472 However, the fill prefix is never taken from a one-line paragraph |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1473 if it would act as a paragraph starter on subsequent lines. |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1474 @end defopt |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1475 |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1476 @defopt adaptive-fill-function |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1477 You can specify more complex ways of choosing a fill prefix |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1478 automatically by setting this variable to a function. The function is |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1479 called when @code{adaptive-fill-regexp} does not match, with point after |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1480 the left margin of a line, and it should return the appropriate fill |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1481 prefix based on that line. If it returns @code{nil}, that means it sees |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1482 no fill prefix in that line. |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1483 @end defopt |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1484 |
6558 | 1485 @node Auto Filling |
1486 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
1487 @section Auto Filling | |
1488 @cindex filling, automatic | |
1489 @cindex Auto Fill mode | |
1490 | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1491 Auto Fill mode is a minor mode that fills lines automatically as text |
12282
586e3ea81792
updates for version 19.29 made by melissa; also needed to check out files
Melissa Weisshaus <melissa@gnu.org>
parents:
12098
diff
changeset
|
1492 is inserted. This section describes the hook used by Auto Fill mode. |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1493 For a description of functions that you can call explicitly to fill and |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1494 justify existing text, see @ref{Filling}. |
6558 | 1495 |
12098 | 1496 Auto Fill mode also enables the functions that change the margins and |
1497 justification style to refill portions of the text. @xref{Margins}. | |
1498 | |
6558 | 1499 @defvar auto-fill-function |
12067 | 1500 The value of this variable should be a function (of no arguments) to be |
28843 | 1501 called after self-inserting a character from the table |
1502 @code{auto-fill-chars}. It may be @code{nil}, in which case nothing | |
1503 special is done in that case. | |
6558 | 1504 |
1505 The value of @code{auto-fill-function} is @code{do-auto-fill} when | |
1506 Auto-Fill mode is enabled. That is a function whose sole purpose is to | |
1507 implement the usual strategy for breaking a line. | |
1508 | |
1509 @quotation | |
1510 In older Emacs versions, this variable was named @code{auto-fill-hook}, | |
1511 but since it is not called with the standard convention for hooks, it | |
1512 was renamed to @code{auto-fill-function} in version 19. | |
1513 @end quotation | |
1514 @end defvar | |
1515 | |
16702
7704b62dafa8
Add normal-auto-fill-function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16398
diff
changeset
|
1516 @defvar normal-auto-fill-function |
7704b62dafa8
Add normal-auto-fill-function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16398
diff
changeset
|
1517 This variable specifies the function to use for |
7704b62dafa8
Add normal-auto-fill-function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16398
diff
changeset
|
1518 @code{auto-fill-function}, if and when Auto Fill is turned on. Major |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1519 modes can set buffer-local values for this variable to alter how Auto |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1520 Fill works. |
16702
7704b62dafa8
Add normal-auto-fill-function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16398
diff
changeset
|
1521 @end defvar |
7704b62dafa8
Add normal-auto-fill-function.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16398
diff
changeset
|
1522 |
28843 | 1523 @defvar auto-fill-chars |
1524 A char table of characters which invoke @code{auto-fill-function} when | |
1525 self-inserted---space and newline in most language environments. They | |
1526 have an entry @code{t} in the table. | |
1527 @end defvar | |
1528 | |
6558 | 1529 @node Sorting |
1530 @section Sorting Text | |
1531 @cindex sorting text | |
1532 | |
1533 The sorting functions described in this section all rearrange text in | |
1534 a buffer. This is in contrast to the function @code{sort}, which | |
1535 rearranges the order of the elements of a list (@pxref{Rearrangement}). | |
1536 The values returned by these functions are not meaningful. | |
1537 | |
1538 @defun sort-subr reverse nextrecfun endrecfun &optional startkeyfun endkeyfun | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1539 This function is the general text-sorting routine that subdivides a |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1540 buffer into records and then sorts them. Most of the commands in this |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1541 section use this function. |
6558 | 1542 |
1543 To understand how @code{sort-subr} works, consider the whole accessible | |
1544 portion of the buffer as being divided into disjoint pieces called | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1545 @dfn{sort records}. The records may or may not be contiguous, but they |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1546 must not overlap. A portion of each sort record (perhaps all of it) is |
6558 | 1547 designated as the sort key. Sorting rearranges the records in order by |
1548 their sort keys. | |
1549 | |
1550 Usually, the records are rearranged in order of ascending sort key. | |
1551 If the first argument to the @code{sort-subr} function, @var{reverse}, | |
1552 is non-@code{nil}, the sort records are rearranged in order of | |
1553 descending sort key. | |
1554 | |
1555 The next four arguments to @code{sort-subr} are functions that are | |
1556 called to move point across a sort record. They are called many times | |
1557 from within @code{sort-subr}. | |
1558 | |
1559 @enumerate | |
1560 @item | |
1561 @var{nextrecfun} is called with point at the end of a record. This | |
1562 function moves point to the start of the next record. The first record | |
1563 is assumed to start at the position of point when @code{sort-subr} is | |
1564 called. Therefore, you should usually move point to the beginning of | |
1565 the buffer before calling @code{sort-subr}. | |
1566 | |
1567 This function can indicate there are no more sort records by leaving | |
1568 point at the end of the buffer. | |
1569 | |
1570 @item | |
1571 @var{endrecfun} is called with point within a record. It moves point to | |
1572 the end of the record. | |
1573 | |
1574 @item | |
1575 @var{startkeyfun} is called to move point from the start of a record to | |
1576 the start of the sort key. This argument is optional; if it is omitted, | |
1577 the whole record is the sort key. If supplied, the function should | |
1578 either return a non-@code{nil} value to be used as the sort key, or | |
1579 return @code{nil} to indicate that the sort key is in the buffer | |
1580 starting at point. In the latter case, @var{endkeyfun} is called to | |
1581 find the end of the sort key. | |
1582 | |
1583 @item | |
1584 @var{endkeyfun} is called to move point from the start of the sort key | |
1585 to the end of the sort key. This argument is optional. If | |
1586 @var{startkeyfun} returns @code{nil} and this argument is omitted (or | |
1587 @code{nil}), then the sort key extends to the end of the record. There | |
1588 is no need for @var{endkeyfun} if @var{startkeyfun} returns a | |
1589 non-@code{nil} value. | |
1590 @end enumerate | |
1591 | |
1592 As an example of @code{sort-subr}, here is the complete function | |
1593 definition for @code{sort-lines}: | |
1594 | |
1595 @example | |
1596 @group | |
1597 ;; @r{Note that the first two lines of doc string} | |
1598 ;; @r{are effectively one line when viewed by a user.} | |
1599 (defun sort-lines (reverse beg end) | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1600 "Sort lines in region alphabetically;\ |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1601 argument means descending order. |
6558 | 1602 Called from a program, there are three arguments: |
1603 @end group | |
1604 @group | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1605 REVERSE (non-nil means reverse order),\ |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1606 BEG and END (region to sort). |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1607 The variable `sort-fold-case' determines\ |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1608 whether alphabetic case affects |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1609 the sort order. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1610 @end group |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1611 @group |
6558 | 1612 (interactive "P\nr") |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1613 (save-excursion |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1614 (save-restriction |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1615 (narrow-to-region beg end) |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1616 (goto-char (point-min)) |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1617 (sort-subr reverse 'forward-line 'end-of-line)))) |
6558 | 1618 @end group |
1619 @end example | |
1620 | |
1621 Here @code{forward-line} moves point to the start of the next record, | |
1622 and @code{end-of-line} moves point to the end of record. We do not pass | |
1623 the arguments @var{startkeyfun} and @var{endkeyfun}, because the entire | |
1624 record is used as the sort key. | |
1625 | |
1626 The @code{sort-paragraphs} function is very much the same, except that | |
1627 its @code{sort-subr} call looks like this: | |
1628 | |
1629 @example | |
1630 @group | |
1631 (sort-subr reverse | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1632 (function |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1633 (lambda () |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1634 (while (and (not (eobp)) |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1635 (looking-at paragraph-separate)) |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1636 (forward-line 1)))) |
6558 | 1637 'forward-paragraph) |
1638 @end group | |
1639 @end example | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1640 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1641 Markers pointing into any sort records are left with no useful |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1642 position after @code{sort-subr} returns. |
6558 | 1643 @end defun |
1644 | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1645 @defopt sort-fold-case |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1646 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, @code{sort-subr} and the other |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1647 buffer sorting functions ignore case when comparing strings. |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1648 @end defopt |
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1649 |
6558 | 1650 @deffn Command sort-regexp-fields reverse record-regexp key-regexp start end |
1651 This command sorts the region between @var{start} and @var{end} | |
1652 alphabetically as specified by @var{record-regexp} and @var{key-regexp}. | |
1653 If @var{reverse} is a negative integer, then sorting is in reverse | |
1654 order. | |
1655 | |
1656 Alphabetical sorting means that two sort keys are compared by | |
1657 comparing the first characters of each, the second characters of each, | |
1658 and so on. If a mismatch is found, it means that the sort keys are | |
1659 unequal; the sort key whose character is less at the point of first | |
1660 mismatch is the lesser sort key. The individual characters are compared | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1661 according to their numerical character codes in the Emacs character set. |
6558 | 1662 |
1663 The value of the @var{record-regexp} argument specifies how to divide | |
1664 the buffer into sort records. At the end of each record, a search is | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1665 done for this regular expression, and the text that matches it is taken |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1666 as the next record. For example, the regular expression @samp{^.+$}, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1667 which matches lines with at least one character besides a newline, would |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1668 make each such line into a sort record. @xref{Regular Expressions}, for |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1669 a description of the syntax and meaning of regular expressions. |
6558 | 1670 |
1671 The value of the @var{key-regexp} argument specifies what part of each | |
1672 record is the sort key. The @var{key-regexp} could match the whole | |
1673 record, or only a part. In the latter case, the rest of the record has | |
1674 no effect on the sorted order of records, but it is carried along when | |
1675 the record moves to its new position. | |
1676 | |
1677 The @var{key-regexp} argument can refer to the text matched by a | |
1678 subexpression of @var{record-regexp}, or it can be a regular expression | |
1679 on its own. | |
1680 | |
1681 If @var{key-regexp} is: | |
1682 | |
1683 @table @asis | |
1684 @item @samp{\@var{digit}} | |
1685 then the text matched by the @var{digit}th @samp{\(...\)} parenthesis | |
1686 grouping in @var{record-regexp} is the sort key. | |
1687 | |
1688 @item @samp{\&} | |
1689 then the whole record is the sort key. | |
1690 | |
1691 @item a regular expression | |
1692 then @code{sort-regexp-fields} searches for a match for the regular | |
1693 expression within the record. If such a match is found, it is the sort | |
1694 key. If there is no match for @var{key-regexp} within a record then | |
1695 that record is ignored, which means its position in the buffer is not | |
1696 changed. (The other records may move around it.) | |
1697 @end table | |
1698 | |
1699 For example, if you plan to sort all the lines in the region by the | |
1700 first word on each line starting with the letter @samp{f}, you should | |
1701 set @var{record-regexp} to @samp{^.*$} and set @var{key-regexp} to | |
1702 @samp{\<f\w*\>}. The resulting expression looks like this: | |
1703 | |
1704 @example | |
1705 @group | |
1706 (sort-regexp-fields nil "^.*$" "\\<f\\w*\\>" | |
1707 (region-beginning) | |
1708 (region-end)) | |
1709 @end group | |
1710 @end example | |
1711 | |
1712 If you call @code{sort-regexp-fields} interactively, it prompts for | |
1713 @var{record-regexp} and @var{key-regexp} in the minibuffer. | |
1714 @end deffn | |
1715 | |
1716 @deffn Command sort-lines reverse start end | |
1717 This command alphabetically sorts lines in the region between | |
1718 @var{start} and @var{end}. If @var{reverse} is non-@code{nil}, the sort | |
1719 is in reverse order. | |
1720 @end deffn | |
1721 | |
1722 @deffn Command sort-paragraphs reverse start end | |
1723 This command alphabetically sorts paragraphs in the region between | |
1724 @var{start} and @var{end}. If @var{reverse} is non-@code{nil}, the sort | |
1725 is in reverse order. | |
1726 @end deffn | |
1727 | |
1728 @deffn Command sort-pages reverse start end | |
1729 This command alphabetically sorts pages in the region between | |
1730 @var{start} and @var{end}. If @var{reverse} is non-@code{nil}, the sort | |
1731 is in reverse order. | |
1732 @end deffn | |
1733 | |
1734 @deffn Command sort-fields field start end | |
1735 This command sorts lines in the region between @var{start} and | |
1736 @var{end}, comparing them alphabetically by the @var{field}th field | |
1737 of each line. Fields are separated by whitespace and numbered starting | |
1738 from 1. If @var{field} is negative, sorting is by the | |
1739 @w{@minus{}@var{field}th} field from the end of the line. This command | |
1740 is useful for sorting tables. | |
1741 @end deffn | |
1742 | |
1743 @deffn Command sort-numeric-fields field start end | |
1744 This command sorts lines in the region between @var{start} and | |
1745 @var{end}, comparing them numerically by the @var{field}th field of each | |
1746 line. The specified field must contain a number in each line of the | |
1747 region. Fields are separated by whitespace and numbered starting from | |
1748 1. If @var{field} is negative, sorting is by the | |
1749 @w{@minus{}@var{field}th} field from the end of the line. This command | |
1750 is useful for sorting tables. | |
1751 @end deffn | |
1752 | |
1753 @deffn Command sort-columns reverse &optional beg end | |
1754 This command sorts the lines in the region between @var{beg} and | |
1755 @var{end}, comparing them alphabetically by a certain range of columns. | |
1756 The column positions of @var{beg} and @var{end} bound the range of | |
1757 columns to sort on. | |
1758 | |
1759 If @var{reverse} is non-@code{nil}, the sort is in reverse order. | |
1760 | |
1761 One unusual thing about this command is that the entire line | |
1762 containing position @var{beg}, and the entire line containing position | |
1763 @var{end}, are included in the region sorted. | |
1764 | |
1765 Note that @code{sort-columns} uses the @code{sort} utility program, | |
1766 and so cannot work properly on text containing tab characters. Use | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1767 @kbd{M-x untabify} to convert tabs to spaces before sorting. |
6558 | 1768 @end deffn |
1769 | |
1770 @node Columns | |
1771 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
1772 @section Counting Columns | |
1773 @cindex columns | |
1774 @cindex counting columns | |
1775 @cindex horizontal position | |
1776 | |
1777 The column functions convert between a character position (counting | |
1778 characters from the beginning of the buffer) and a column position | |
1779 (counting screen characters from the beginning of a line). | |
1780 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1781 These functions count each character according to the number of |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1782 columns it occupies on the screen. This means control characters count |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1783 as occupying 2 or 4 columns, depending upon the value of |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1784 @code{ctl-arrow}, and tabs count as occupying a number of columns that |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1785 depends on the value of @code{tab-width} and on the column where the tab |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
1786 begins. @xref{Usual Display}. |
6558 | 1787 |
1788 Column number computations ignore the width of the window and the | |
1789 amount of horizontal scrolling. Consequently, a column value can be | |
1790 arbitrarily high. The first (or leftmost) column is numbered 0. | |
1791 | |
1792 @defun current-column | |
1793 This function returns the horizontal position of point, measured in | |
1794 columns, counting from 0 at the left margin. The column position is the | |
1795 sum of the widths of all the displayed representations of the characters | |
1796 between the start of the current line and point. | |
1797 | |
1798 For an example of using @code{current-column}, see the description of | |
1799 @code{count-lines} in @ref{Text Lines}. | |
1800 @end defun | |
1801 | |
1802 @defun move-to-column column &optional force | |
1803 This function moves point to @var{column} in the current line. The | |
1804 calculation of @var{column} takes into account the widths of the | |
1805 displayed representations of the characters between the start of the | |
1806 line and point. | |
1807 | |
1808 If column @var{column} is beyond the end of the line, point moves to the | |
1809 end of the line. If @var{column} is negative, point moves to the | |
1810 beginning of the line. | |
1811 | |
1812 If it is impossible to move to column @var{column} because that is in | |
1813 the middle of a multicolumn character such as a tab, point moves to the | |
1814 end of that character. However, if @var{force} is non-@code{nil}, and | |
1815 @var{column} is in the middle of a tab, then @code{move-to-column} | |
1816 converts the tab into spaces so that it can move precisely to column | |
1817 @var{column}. Other multicolumn characters can cause anomalies despite | |
1818 @var{force}, since there is no way to split them. | |
1819 | |
1820 The argument @var{force} also has an effect if the line isn't long | |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
1821 enough to reach column @var{column}; if it is @code{t}, that means to |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
1822 add whitespace at the end of the line to reach that column. |
6558 | 1823 |
1824 If @var{column} is not an integer, an error is signaled. | |
1825 | |
1826 The return value is the column number actually moved to. | |
1827 @end defun | |
1828 | |
1829 @node Indentation | |
1830 @section Indentation | |
1831 @cindex indentation | |
1832 | |
1833 The indentation functions are used to examine, move to, and change | |
1834 whitespace that is at the beginning of a line. Some of the functions | |
1835 can also change whitespace elsewhere on a line. Columns and indentation | |
1836 count from zero at the left margin. | |
1837 | |
1838 @menu | |
1839 * Primitive Indent:: Functions used to count and insert indentation. | |
1840 * Mode-Specific Indent:: Customize indentation for different modes. | |
1841 * Region Indent:: Indent all the lines in a region. | |
1842 * Relative Indent:: Indent the current line based on previous lines. | |
1843 * Indent Tabs:: Adjustable, typewriter-like tab stops. | |
1844 * Motion by Indent:: Move to first non-blank character. | |
1845 @end menu | |
1846 | |
1847 @node Primitive Indent | |
1848 @subsection Indentation Primitives | |
1849 | |
1850 This section describes the primitive functions used to count and | |
1851 insert indentation. The functions in the following sections use these | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1852 primitives. @xref{Width}, for related functions. |
6558 | 1853 |
1854 @defun current-indentation | |
1855 @comment !!Type Primitive Function | |
1856 @comment !!SourceFile indent.c | |
1857 This function returns the indentation of the current line, which is | |
1858 the horizontal position of the first nonblank character. If the | |
1859 contents are entirely blank, then this is the horizontal position of the | |
1860 end of the line. | |
1861 @end defun | |
1862 | |
1863 @deffn Command indent-to column &optional minimum | |
1864 @comment !!Type Primitive Function | |
1865 @comment !!SourceFile indent.c | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1866 This function indents from point with tabs and spaces until @var{column} |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1867 is reached. If @var{minimum} is specified and non-@code{nil}, then at |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1868 least that many spaces are inserted even if this requires going beyond |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1869 @var{column}. Otherwise the function does nothing if point is already |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1870 beyond @var{column}. The value is the column at which the inserted |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1871 indentation ends. |
8644 | 1872 |
1873 The inserted whitespace characters inherit text properties from the | |
1874 surrounding text (usually, from the preceding text only). @xref{Sticky | |
1875 Properties}. | |
6558 | 1876 @end deffn |
1877 | |
1878 @defopt indent-tabs-mode | |
1879 @comment !!SourceFile indent.c | |
1880 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, indentation functions can insert | |
1881 tabs as well as spaces. Otherwise, they insert only spaces. Setting | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
1882 this variable automatically makes it buffer-local in the current buffer. |
6558 | 1883 @end defopt |
1884 | |
1885 @node Mode-Specific Indent | |
1886 @subsection Indentation Controlled by Major Mode | |
1887 | |
1888 An important function of each major mode is to customize the @key{TAB} | |
1889 key to indent properly for the language being edited. This section | |
1890 describes the mechanism of the @key{TAB} key and how to control it. | |
1891 The functions in this section return unpredictable values. | |
1892 | |
1893 @defvar indent-line-function | |
1894 This variable's value is the function to be used by @key{TAB} (and | |
1895 various commands) to indent the current line. The command | |
1896 @code{indent-according-to-mode} does no more than call this function. | |
1897 | |
1898 In Lisp mode, the value is the symbol @code{lisp-indent-line}; in C | |
1899 mode, @code{c-indent-line}; in Fortran mode, @code{fortran-indent-line}. | |
1900 In Fundamental mode, Text mode, and many other modes with no standard | |
1901 for indentation, the value is @code{indent-to-left-margin} (which is the | |
1902 default value). | |
1903 @end defvar | |
1904 | |
1905 @deffn Command indent-according-to-mode | |
1906 This command calls the function in @code{indent-line-function} to | |
1907 indent the current line in a way appropriate for the current major mode. | |
1908 @end deffn | |
1909 | |
1910 @deffn Command indent-for-tab-command | |
1911 This command calls the function in @code{indent-line-function} to indent | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1912 the current line; however, if that function is |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1913 @code{indent-to-left-margin}, @code{insert-tab} is called instead. (That |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1914 is a trivial command that inserts a tab character.) |
6558 | 1915 @end deffn |
1916 | |
1917 @deffn Command newline-and-indent | |
1918 @comment !!SourceFile simple.el | |
1919 This function inserts a newline, then indents the new line (the one | |
1920 following the newline just inserted) according to the major mode. | |
1921 | |
1922 It does indentation by calling the current @code{indent-line-function}. | |
1923 In programming language modes, this is the same thing @key{TAB} does, | |
1924 but in some text modes, where @key{TAB} inserts a tab, | |
1925 @code{newline-and-indent} indents to the column specified by | |
1926 @code{left-margin}. | |
1927 @end deffn | |
1928 | |
1929 @deffn Command reindent-then-newline-and-indent | |
1930 @comment !!SourceFile simple.el | |
1931 This command reindents the current line, inserts a newline at point, | |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
1932 and then indents the new line (the one following the newline just |
6558 | 1933 inserted). |
1934 | |
1935 This command does indentation on both lines according to the current | |
1936 major mode, by calling the current value of @code{indent-line-function}. | |
1937 In programming language modes, this is the same thing @key{TAB} does, | |
1938 but in some text modes, where @key{TAB} inserts a tab, | |
1939 @code{reindent-then-newline-and-indent} indents to the column specified | |
1940 by @code{left-margin}. | |
1941 @end deffn | |
1942 | |
1943 @node Region Indent | |
1944 @subsection Indenting an Entire Region | |
1945 | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1946 This section describes commands that indent all the lines in the |
6558 | 1947 region. They return unpredictable values. |
1948 | |
1949 @deffn Command indent-region start end to-column | |
1950 This command indents each nonblank line starting between @var{start} | |
1951 (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive). If @var{to-column} is | |
1952 @code{nil}, @code{indent-region} indents each nonblank line by calling | |
1953 the current mode's indentation function, the value of | |
1954 @code{indent-line-function}. | |
1955 | |
1956 If @var{to-column} is non-@code{nil}, it should be an integer | |
1957 specifying the number of columns of indentation; then this function | |
1958 gives each line exactly that much indentation, by either adding or | |
1959 deleting whitespace. | |
1960 | |
1961 If there is a fill prefix, @code{indent-region} indents each line | |
1962 by making it start with the fill prefix. | |
1963 @end deffn | |
1964 | |
1965 @defvar indent-region-function | |
1966 The value of this variable is a function that can be used by | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1967 @code{indent-region} as a short cut. It should take two arguments, the |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
1968 start and end of the region. You should design the function so |
6558 | 1969 that it will produce the same results as indenting the lines of the |
1970 region one by one, but presumably faster. | |
1971 | |
1972 If the value is @code{nil}, there is no short cut, and | |
1973 @code{indent-region} actually works line by line. | |
1974 | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1975 A short-cut function is useful in modes such as C mode and Lisp mode, |
6558 | 1976 where the @code{indent-line-function} must scan from the beginning of |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1977 the function definition: applying it to each line would be quadratic in |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1978 time. The short cut can update the scan information as it moves through |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1979 the lines indenting them; this takes linear time. In a mode where |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1980 indenting a line individually is fast, there is no need for a short cut. |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1981 |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1982 @code{indent-region} with a non-@code{nil} argument @var{to-column} has |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
1983 a different meaning and does not use this variable. |
6558 | 1984 @end defvar |
1985 | |
1986 @deffn Command indent-rigidly start end count | |
1987 @comment !!SourceFile indent.el | |
1988 This command indents all lines starting between @var{start} | |
1989 (inclusive) and @var{end} (exclusive) sideways by @var{count} columns. | |
1990 This ``preserves the shape'' of the affected region, moving it as a | |
1991 rigid unit. Consequently, this command is useful not only for indenting | |
1992 regions of unindented text, but also for indenting regions of formatted | |
1993 code. | |
1994 | |
1995 For example, if @var{count} is 3, this command adds 3 columns of | |
1996 indentation to each of the lines beginning in the region specified. | |
1997 | |
1998 In Mail mode, @kbd{C-c C-y} (@code{mail-yank-original}) uses | |
1999 @code{indent-rigidly} to indent the text copied from the message being | |
2000 replied to. | |
2001 @end deffn | |
2002 | |
2003 @defun indent-code-rigidly start end columns &optional nochange-regexp | |
2004 This is like @code{indent-rigidly}, except that it doesn't alter lines | |
2005 that start within strings or comments. | |
2006 | |
2007 In addition, it doesn't alter a line if @var{nochange-regexp} matches at | |
2008 the beginning of the line (if @var{nochange-regexp} is non-@code{nil}). | |
2009 @end defun | |
2010 | |
2011 @node Relative Indent | |
2012 @subsection Indentation Relative to Previous Lines | |
2013 | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2014 This section describes two commands that indent the current line |
6558 | 2015 based on the contents of previous lines. |
2016 | |
2017 @deffn Command indent-relative &optional unindented-ok | |
2018 This command inserts whitespace at point, extending to the same | |
2019 column as the next @dfn{indent point} of the previous nonblank line. An | |
2020 indent point is a non-whitespace character following whitespace. The | |
2021 next indent point is the first one at a column greater than the current | |
2022 column of point. For example, if point is underneath and to the left of | |
2023 the first non-blank character of a line of text, it moves to that column | |
2024 by inserting whitespace. | |
2025 | |
2026 If the previous nonblank line has no next indent point (i.e., none at a | |
2027 great enough column position), @code{indent-relative} either does | |
2028 nothing (if @var{unindented-ok} is non-@code{nil}) or calls | |
2029 @code{tab-to-tab-stop}. Thus, if point is underneath and to the right | |
2030 of the last column of a short line of text, this command ordinarily | |
2031 moves point to the next tab stop by inserting whitespace. | |
2032 | |
2033 The return value of @code{indent-relative} is unpredictable. | |
2034 | |
2035 In the following example, point is at the beginning of the second | |
2036 line: | |
2037 | |
2038 @example | |
2039 @group | |
2040 This line is indented twelve spaces. | |
2041 @point{}The quick brown fox jumped. | |
2042 @end group | |
2043 @end example | |
2044 | |
2045 @noindent | |
2046 Evaluation of the expression @code{(indent-relative nil)} produces the | |
2047 following: | |
2048 | |
2049 @example | |
2050 @group | |
2051 This line is indented twelve spaces. | |
2052 @point{}The quick brown fox jumped. | |
2053 @end group | |
2054 @end example | |
2055 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2056 In this next example, point is between the @samp{m} and @samp{p} of |
6558 | 2057 @samp{jumped}: |
2058 | |
2059 @example | |
2060 @group | |
2061 This line is indented twelve spaces. | |
2062 The quick brown fox jum@point{}ped. | |
2063 @end group | |
2064 @end example | |
2065 | |
2066 @noindent | |
2067 Evaluation of the expression @code{(indent-relative nil)} produces the | |
2068 following: | |
2069 | |
2070 @example | |
2071 @group | |
2072 This line is indented twelve spaces. | |
2073 The quick brown fox jum @point{}ped. | |
2074 @end group | |
2075 @end example | |
2076 @end deffn | |
2077 | |
2078 @deffn Command indent-relative-maybe | |
2079 @comment !!SourceFile indent.el | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2080 This command indents the current line like the previous nonblank line, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2081 by calling @code{indent-relative} with @code{t} as the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2082 @var{unindented-ok} argument. The return value is unpredictable. |
6558 | 2083 |
2084 If the previous nonblank line has no indent points beyond the current | |
2085 column, this command does nothing. | |
2086 @end deffn | |
2087 | |
2088 @node Indent Tabs | |
2089 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
2090 @subsection Adjustable ``Tab Stops'' | |
2091 @cindex tabs stops for indentation | |
2092 | |
2093 This section explains the mechanism for user-specified ``tab stops'' | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2094 and the mechanisms that use and set them. The name ``tab stops'' is |
6558 | 2095 used because the feature is similar to that of the tab stops on a |
2096 typewriter. The feature works by inserting an appropriate number of | |
2097 spaces and tab characters to reach the next tab stop column; it does not | |
2098 affect the display of tab characters in the buffer (@pxref{Usual | |
2099 Display}). Note that the @key{TAB} character as input uses this tab | |
2100 stop feature only in a few major modes, such as Text mode. | |
2101 | |
2102 @deffn Command tab-to-tab-stop | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2103 This command inserts spaces or tabs before point, up to the next tab |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2104 stop column defined by @code{tab-stop-list}. It searches the list for |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2105 an element greater than the current column number, and uses that element |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2106 as the column to indent to. It does nothing if no such element is |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2107 found. |
6558 | 2108 @end deffn |
2109 | |
2110 @defopt tab-stop-list | |
2111 This variable is the list of tab stop columns used by | |
2112 @code{tab-to-tab-stops}. The elements should be integers in increasing | |
2113 order. The tab stop columns need not be evenly spaced. | |
2114 | |
2115 Use @kbd{M-x edit-tab-stops} to edit the location of tab stops | |
2116 interactively. | |
2117 @end defopt | |
2118 | |
2119 @node Motion by Indent | |
2120 @subsection Indentation-Based Motion Commands | |
2121 | |
2122 These commands, primarily for interactive use, act based on the | |
2123 indentation in the text. | |
2124 | |
2125 @deffn Command back-to-indentation | |
2126 @comment !!SourceFile simple.el | |
2127 This command moves point to the first non-whitespace character in the | |
2128 current line (which is the line in which point is located). It returns | |
2129 @code{nil}. | |
2130 @end deffn | |
2131 | |
2132 @deffn Command backward-to-indentation arg | |
2133 @comment !!SourceFile simple.el | |
2134 This command moves point backward @var{arg} lines and then to the | |
2135 first nonblank character on that line. It returns @code{nil}. | |
2136 @end deffn | |
2137 | |
2138 @deffn Command forward-to-indentation arg | |
2139 @comment !!SourceFile simple.el | |
2140 This command moves point forward @var{arg} lines and then to the first | |
2141 nonblank character on that line. It returns @code{nil}. | |
2142 @end deffn | |
2143 | |
2144 @node Case Changes | |
2145 @comment node-name, next, previous, up | |
2146 @section Case Changes | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2147 @cindex case conversion in buffers |
6558 | 2148 |
2149 The case change commands described here work on text in the current | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2150 buffer. @xref{Case Conversion}, for case conversion functions that work |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2151 on strings and characters. @xref{Case Tables}, for how to customize |
6558 | 2152 which characters are upper or lower case and how to convert them. |
2153 | |
2154 @deffn Command capitalize-region start end | |
2155 This function capitalizes all words in the region defined by | |
2156 @var{start} and @var{end}. To capitalize means to convert each word's | |
2157 first character to upper case and convert the rest of each word to lower | |
2158 case. The function returns @code{nil}. | |
2159 | |
2160 If one end of the region is in the middle of a word, the part of the | |
2161 word within the region is treated as an entire word. | |
2162 | |
2163 When @code{capitalize-region} is called interactively, @var{start} and | |
2164 @var{end} are point and the mark, with the smallest first. | |
2165 | |
2166 @example | |
2167 @group | |
2168 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
2169 This is the contents of the 5th foo. | |
2170 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
2171 @end group | |
2172 | |
2173 @group | |
2174 (capitalize-region 1 44) | |
2175 @result{} nil | |
2176 | |
2177 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
2178 This Is The Contents Of The 5th Foo. | |
2179 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
2180 @end group | |
2181 @end example | |
2182 @end deffn | |
2183 | |
2184 @deffn Command downcase-region start end | |
2185 This function converts all of the letters in the region defined by | |
2186 @var{start} and @var{end} to lower case. The function returns | |
2187 @code{nil}. | |
2188 | |
2189 When @code{downcase-region} is called interactively, @var{start} and | |
2190 @var{end} are point and the mark, with the smallest first. | |
2191 @end deffn | |
2192 | |
2193 @deffn Command upcase-region start end | |
2194 This function converts all of the letters in the region defined by | |
2195 @var{start} and @var{end} to upper case. The function returns | |
2196 @code{nil}. | |
2197 | |
2198 When @code{upcase-region} is called interactively, @var{start} and | |
2199 @var{end} are point and the mark, with the smallest first. | |
2200 @end deffn | |
2201 | |
2202 @deffn Command capitalize-word count | |
2203 This function capitalizes @var{count} words after point, moving point | |
2204 over as it does. To capitalize means to convert each word's first | |
2205 character to upper case and convert the rest of each word to lower case. | |
2206 If @var{count} is negative, the function capitalizes the | |
2207 @minus{}@var{count} previous words but does not move point. The value | |
2208 is @code{nil}. | |
2209 | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2210 If point is in the middle of a word, the part of the word before point |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2211 is ignored when moving forward. The rest is treated as an entire word. |
6558 | 2212 |
2213 When @code{capitalize-word} is called interactively, @var{count} is | |
2214 set to the numeric prefix argument. | |
2215 @end deffn | |
2216 | |
2217 @deffn Command downcase-word count | |
2218 This function converts the @var{count} words after point to all lower | |
2219 case, moving point over as it does. If @var{count} is negative, it | |
2220 converts the @minus{}@var{count} previous words but does not move point. | |
2221 The value is @code{nil}. | |
2222 | |
2223 When @code{downcase-word} is called interactively, @var{count} is set | |
2224 to the numeric prefix argument. | |
2225 @end deffn | |
2226 | |
2227 @deffn Command upcase-word count | |
2228 This function converts the @var{count} words after point to all upper | |
2229 case, moving point over as it does. If @var{count} is negative, it | |
2230 converts the @minus{}@var{count} previous words but does not move point. | |
2231 The value is @code{nil}. | |
2232 | |
2233 When @code{upcase-word} is called interactively, @var{count} is set to | |
2234 the numeric prefix argument. | |
2235 @end deffn | |
2236 | |
2237 @node Text Properties | |
2238 @section Text Properties | |
2239 @cindex text properties | |
2240 @cindex attributes of text | |
2241 @cindex properties of text | |
2242 | |
2243 Each character position in a buffer or a string can have a @dfn{text | |
2244 property list}, much like the property list of a symbol (@pxref{Property | |
2245 Lists}). The properties belong to a particular character at a | |
2246 particular place, such as, the letter @samp{T} at the beginning of this | |
2247 sentence or the first @samp{o} in @samp{foo}---if the same character | |
2248 occurs in two different places, the two occurrences generally have | |
2249 different properties. | |
2250 | |
2251 Each property has a name and a value. Both of these can be any Lisp | |
2252 object, but the name is normally a symbol. The usual way to access the | |
2253 property list is to specify a name and ask what value corresponds to it. | |
2254 | |
2255 If a character has a @code{category} property, we call it the | |
2256 @dfn{category} of the character. It should be a symbol. The properties | |
2257 of the symbol serve as defaults for the properties of the character. | |
2258 | |
2259 Copying text between strings and buffers preserves the properties | |
2260 along with the characters; this includes such diverse functions as | |
2261 @code{substring}, @code{insert}, and @code{buffer-substring}. | |
2262 | |
2263 @menu | |
2264 * Examining Properties:: Looking at the properties of one character. | |
2265 * Changing Properties:: Setting the properties of a range of text. | |
2266 * Property Search:: Searching for where a property changes value. | |
2267 * Special Properties:: Particular properties with special meanings. | |
12067 | 2268 * Format Properties:: Properties for representing formatting of text. |
6558 | 2269 * Sticky Properties:: How inserted text gets properties from |
2270 neighboring text. | |
2271 * Saving Properties:: Saving text properties in files, and reading | |
2272 them back. | |
15760
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
2273 * Lazy Properties:: Computing text properties in a lazy fashion |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
2274 only when text is examined. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2275 * Clickable Text:: Using text properties to make regions of text |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2276 do something when you click on them. |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2277 * Fields:: The @code{field} property defines |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2278 fields within the buffer. |
6558 | 2279 * Not Intervals:: Why text properties do not use |
2280 Lisp-visible text intervals. | |
2281 @end menu | |
2282 | |
2283 @node Examining Properties | |
2284 @subsection Examining Text Properties | |
2285 | |
2286 The simplest way to examine text properties is to ask for the value of | |
2287 a particular property of a particular character. For that, use | |
2288 @code{get-text-property}. Use @code{text-properties-at} to get the | |
2289 entire property list of a character. @xref{Property Search}, for | |
2290 functions to examine the properties of a number of characters at once. | |
2291 | |
2292 These functions handle both strings and buffers. Keep in mind that | |
2293 positions in a string start from 0, whereas positions in a buffer start | |
2294 from 1. | |
2295 | |
2296 @defun get-text-property pos prop &optional object | |
2297 This function returns the value of the @var{prop} property of the | |
2298 character after position @var{pos} in @var{object} (a buffer or | |
2299 string). The argument @var{object} is optional and defaults to the | |
2300 current buffer. | |
2301 | |
2302 If there is no @var{prop} property strictly speaking, but the character | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2303 has a category that is a symbol, then @code{get-text-property} returns |
6558 | 2304 the @var{prop} property of that symbol. |
2305 @end defun | |
2306 | |
2307 @defun get-char-property pos prop &optional object | |
2308 This function is like @code{get-text-property}, except that it checks | |
2309 overlays first and then text properties. @xref{Overlays}. | |
2310 | |
2311 The argument @var{object} may be a string, a buffer, or a window. If it | |
2312 is a window, then the buffer displayed in that window is used for text | |
2313 properties and overlays, but only the overlays active for that window | |
2314 are considered. If @var{object} is a buffer, then all overlays in that | |
2315 buffer are considered, as well as text properties. If @var{object} is a | |
2316 string, only text properties are considered, since strings never have | |
2317 overlays. | |
2318 @end defun | |
2319 | |
2320 @defun text-properties-at position &optional object | |
2321 This function returns the entire property list of the character at | |
2322 @var{position} in the string or buffer @var{object}. If @var{object} is | |
2323 @code{nil}, it defaults to the current buffer. | |
2324 @end defun | |
2325 | |
12067 | 2326 @defvar default-text-properties |
2327 This variable holds a property list giving default values for text | |
2328 properties. Whenever a character does not specify a value for a | |
12098 | 2329 property, neither directly nor through a category symbol, the value |
2330 stored in this list is used instead. Here is an example: | |
12067 | 2331 |
2332 @example | |
2333 (setq default-text-properties '(foo 69)) | |
2334 ;; @r{Make sure character 1 has no properties of its own.} | |
2335 (set-text-properties 1 2 nil) | |
2336 ;; @r{What we get, when we ask, is the default value.} | |
2337 (get-text-property 1 'foo) | |
2338 @result{} 69 | |
2339 @end example | |
2340 @end defvar | |
2341 | |
6558 | 2342 @node Changing Properties |
2343 @subsection Changing Text Properties | |
2344 | |
2345 The primitives for changing properties apply to a specified range of | |
18339
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2346 text in a buffer or string. The function @code{set-text-properties} |
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2347 (see end of section) sets the entire property list of the text in that |
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2348 range; more often, it is useful to add, change, or delete just certain |
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2349 properties specified by name. |
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2350 |
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2351 Since text properties are considered part of the contents of the |
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2352 buffer (or string), and can affect how a buffer looks on the screen, any |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2353 change in buffer text properties marks the buffer as modified. Buffer |
18339
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2354 text property changes are undoable also (@pxref{Undo}). |
6558 | 2355 |
12098 | 2356 @defun put-text-property start end prop value &optional object |
2357 This function sets the @var{prop} property to @var{value} for the text | |
2358 between @var{start} and @var{end} in the string or buffer @var{object}. | |
2359 If @var{object} is @code{nil}, it defaults to the current buffer. | |
2360 @end defun | |
2361 | |
6558 | 2362 @defun add-text-properties start end props &optional object |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2363 This function adds or overrides text properties for the text between |
6558 | 2364 @var{start} and @var{end} in the string or buffer @var{object}. If |
2365 @var{object} is @code{nil}, it defaults to the current buffer. | |
2366 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2367 The argument @var{props} specifies which properties to add. It should |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2368 have the form of a property list (@pxref{Property Lists}): a list whose |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2369 elements include the property names followed alternately by the |
6558 | 2370 corresponding values. |
2371 | |
2372 The return value is @code{t} if the function actually changed some | |
2373 property's value; @code{nil} otherwise (if @var{props} is @code{nil} or | |
2374 its values agree with those in the text). | |
2375 | |
2376 For example, here is how to set the @code{comment} and @code{face} | |
2377 properties of a range of text: | |
2378 | |
2379 @example | |
2380 (add-text-properties @var{start} @var{end} | |
2381 '(comment t face highlight)) | |
2382 @end example | |
2383 @end defun | |
2384 | |
2385 @defun remove-text-properties start end props &optional object | |
2386 This function deletes specified text properties from the text between | |
2387 @var{start} and @var{end} in the string or buffer @var{object}. If | |
2388 @var{object} is @code{nil}, it defaults to the current buffer. | |
2389 | |
2390 The argument @var{props} specifies which properties to delete. It | |
2391 should have the form of a property list (@pxref{Property Lists}): a list | |
2392 whose elements are property names alternating with corresponding values. | |
2393 But only the names matter---the values that accompany them are ignored. | |
2394 For example, here's how to remove the @code{face} property. | |
2395 | |
2396 @example | |
2397 (remove-text-properties @var{start} @var{end} '(face nil)) | |
2398 @end example | |
2399 | |
2400 The return value is @code{t} if the function actually changed some | |
2401 property's value; @code{nil} otherwise (if @var{props} is @code{nil} or | |
2402 if no character in the specified text had any of those properties). | |
18339
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2403 |
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2404 To remove all text properties from certain text, use |
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2405 @code{set-text-properties} and specify @code{nil} for the new property |
7def48db254a
Clarify about text props in strings and how to remove all of them.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
16934
diff
changeset
|
2406 list. |
6558 | 2407 @end defun |
2408 | |
2409 @defun set-text-properties start end props &optional object | |
2410 This function completely replaces the text property list for the text | |
2411 between @var{start} and @var{end} in the string or buffer @var{object}. | |
2412 If @var{object} is @code{nil}, it defaults to the current buffer. | |
2413 | |
2414 The argument @var{props} is the new property list. It should be a list | |
2415 whose elements are property names alternating with corresponding values. | |
2416 | |
2417 After @code{set-text-properties} returns, all the characters in the | |
2418 specified range have identical properties. | |
2419 | |
2420 If @var{props} is @code{nil}, the effect is to get rid of all properties | |
2421 from the specified range of text. Here's an example: | |
2422 | |
2423 @example | |
2424 (set-text-properties @var{start} @var{end} nil) | |
2425 @end example | |
2426 @end defun | |
2427 | |
25875 | 2428 The easiest way to make a string with text properties |
2429 is with @code{propertize}: | |
2430 | |
2431 @defun propertize string &rest properties | |
2432 @tindex propertize | |
2433 This function returns a copy of @var{string} which has the text | |
2434 properties @var{properties}. These properties apply to all the | |
2435 characters in the string that is returned. Here is an example that | |
2436 constructs a string with a @code{face} property and a @code{mouse-face} | |
2437 property: | |
2438 | |
2439 @smallexample | |
2440 (propertize "foo" 'face 'italic | |
2441 'mouse-face 'bold-italic) | |
2442 @result{} #("foo" 0 3 (mouse-face bold-italic face italic)) | |
2443 @end smallexample | |
2444 | |
2445 To put different properties on various parts of a string, you can | |
2446 construct each part with @code{propertize} and then combine them with | |
2447 @code{concat}: | |
2448 | |
2449 @smallexample | |
2450 (concat | |
2451 (propertize "foo" 'face 'italic | |
2452 'mouse-face 'bold-italic) | |
2453 " and " | |
2454 (propertize "bar" 'face 'italic | |
2455 'mouse-face 'bold-italic)) | |
2456 @result{} #("foo and bar" | |
2457 0 3 (face italic mouse-face bold-italic) | |
2458 3 8 nil | |
2459 8 11 (face italic mouse-face bold-italic)) | |
2460 @end smallexample | |
2461 @end defun | |
2462 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2463 See also the function @code{buffer-substring-no-properties} |
12067 | 2464 (@pxref{Buffer Contents}) which copies text from the buffer |
2465 but does not copy its properties. | |
2466 | |
6558 | 2467 @node Property Search |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2468 @subsection Text Property Search Functions |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2469 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2470 In typical use of text properties, most of the time several or many |
6558 | 2471 consecutive characters have the same value for a property. Rather than |
2472 writing your programs to examine characters one by one, it is much | |
2473 faster to process chunks of text that have the same property value. | |
2474 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2475 Here are functions you can use to do this. They use @code{eq} for |
12098 | 2476 comparing property values. In all cases, @var{object} defaults to the |
2477 current buffer. | |
6558 | 2478 |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2479 For high performance, it's very important to use the @var{limit} |
6558 | 2480 argument to these functions, especially the ones that search for a |
12098 | 2481 single property---otherwise, they may spend a long time scanning to the |
2482 end of the buffer, if the property you are interested in does not change. | |
6558 | 2483 |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2484 These functions do not move point; instead, they return a position (or |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2485 @code{nil}). Remember that a position is always between two characters; |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2486 the position returned by these functions is between two characters with |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2487 different properties. |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2488 |
6558 | 2489 @defun next-property-change pos &optional object limit |
2490 The function scans the text forward from position @var{pos} in the | |
2491 string or buffer @var{object} till it finds a change in some text | |
2492 property, then returns the position of the change. In other words, it | |
2493 returns the position of the first character beyond @var{pos} whose | |
2494 properties are not identical to those of the character just after | |
2495 @var{pos}. | |
2496 | |
2497 If @var{limit} is non-@code{nil}, then the scan ends at position | |
2498 @var{limit}. If there is no property change before that point, | |
2499 @code{next-property-change} returns @var{limit}. | |
2500 | |
2501 The value is @code{nil} if the properties remain unchanged all the way | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2502 to the end of @var{object} and @var{limit} is @code{nil}. If the value |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2503 is non-@code{nil}, it is a position greater than or equal to @var{pos}. |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2504 The value equals @var{pos} only when @var{limit} equals @var{pos}. |
6558 | 2505 |
2506 Here is an example of how to scan the buffer by chunks of text within | |
2507 which all properties are constant: | |
2508 | |
2509 @smallexample | |
2510 (while (not (eobp)) | |
2511 (let ((plist (text-properties-at (point))) | |
2512 (next-change | |
2513 (or (next-property-change (point) (current-buffer)) | |
2514 (point-max)))) | |
2515 @r{Process text from point to @var{next-change}@dots{}} | |
2516 (goto-char next-change))) | |
2517 @end smallexample | |
2518 @end defun | |
2519 | |
2520 @defun next-single-property-change pos prop &optional object limit | |
2521 The function scans the text forward from position @var{pos} in the | |
2522 string or buffer @var{object} till it finds a change in the @var{prop} | |
2523 property, then returns the position of the change. In other words, it | |
2524 returns the position of the first character beyond @var{pos} whose | |
2525 @var{prop} property differs from that of the character just after | |
2526 @var{pos}. | |
2527 | |
2528 If @var{limit} is non-@code{nil}, then the scan ends at position | |
2529 @var{limit}. If there is no property change before that point, | |
2530 @code{next-single-property-change} returns @var{limit}. | |
2531 | |
2532 The value is @code{nil} if the property remains unchanged all the way to | |
2533 the end of @var{object} and @var{limit} is @code{nil}. If the value is | |
2534 non-@code{nil}, it is a position greater than or equal to @var{pos}; it | |
2535 equals @var{pos} only if @var{limit} equals @var{pos}. | |
2536 @end defun | |
2537 | |
2538 @defun previous-property-change pos &optional object limit | |
2539 This is like @code{next-property-change}, but scans back from @var{pos} | |
2540 instead of forward. If the value is non-@code{nil}, it is a position | |
2541 less than or equal to @var{pos}; it equals @var{pos} only if @var{limit} | |
2542 equals @var{pos}. | |
2543 @end defun | |
2544 | |
2545 @defun previous-single-property-change pos prop &optional object limit | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2546 This is like @code{next-single-property-change}, but scans back from |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2547 @var{pos} instead of forward. If the value is non-@code{nil}, it is a |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2548 position less than or equal to @var{pos}; it equals @var{pos} only if |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2549 @var{limit} equals @var{pos}. |
6558 | 2550 @end defun |
2551 | |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
2552 @defun next-char-property-change position &optional limit |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2553 This is like @code{next-property-change} except that it considers |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2554 overlay properties as well as text properties. There is no @var{object} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2555 operand because this function operates only on the current buffer. It |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2556 returns the next address at which either kind of property changes. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2557 @end defun |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2558 |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
2559 @defun previous-char-property-change position &optional limit |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2560 This is like @code{next-char-property-change}, but scans back from |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2561 @var{position} instead of forward. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2562 @end defun |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2563 |
6558 | 2564 @defun text-property-any start end prop value &optional object |
2565 This function returns non-@code{nil} if at least one character between | |
2566 @var{start} and @var{end} has a property @var{prop} whose value is | |
2567 @var{value}. More precisely, it returns the position of the first such | |
2568 character. Otherwise, it returns @code{nil}. | |
2569 | |
2570 The optional fifth argument, @var{object}, specifies the string or | |
2571 buffer to scan. Positions are relative to @var{object}. The default | |
2572 for @var{object} is the current buffer. | |
2573 @end defun | |
2574 | |
2575 @defun text-property-not-all start end prop value &optional object | |
2576 This function returns non-@code{nil} if at least one character between | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2577 @var{start} and @var{end} does not have a property @var{prop} with value |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2578 @var{value}. More precisely, it returns the position of the first such |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2579 character. Otherwise, it returns @code{nil}. |
6558 | 2580 |
2581 The optional fifth argument, @var{object}, specifies the string or | |
2582 buffer to scan. Positions are relative to @var{object}. The default | |
2583 for @var{object} is the current buffer. | |
2584 @end defun | |
2585 | |
2586 @node Special Properties | |
2587 @subsection Properties with Special Meanings | |
2588 | |
12098 | 2589 Here is a table of text property names that have special built-in |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2590 meanings. The following sections list a few additional special property |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2591 names that control filling and property inheritance. All other names |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
2592 have no standard meaning, and you can use them as you like. |
12098 | 2593 |
6558 | 2594 @table @code |
2595 @cindex category of text character | |
2596 @kindex category @r{(text property)} | |
2597 @item category | |
2598 If a character has a @code{category} property, we call it the | |
2599 @dfn{category} of the character. It should be a symbol. The properties | |
2600 of the symbol serve as defaults for the properties of the character. | |
2601 | |
2602 @item face | |
2603 @cindex face codes of text | |
2604 @kindex face @r{(text property)} | |
2605 You can use the property @code{face} to control the font and color of | |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2606 text. @xref{Faces}, for more information. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2607 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2608 In the simplest case, the value is a face name. It can also be a list; |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2609 then each element can be any of these possibilities; |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2610 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2611 @itemize @bullet |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2612 @item |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2613 A face name (a symbol or string). |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2614 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2615 @item |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2616 Starting in Emacs 21, a property list of face attributes. This has the |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2617 form (@var{keyword} @var{value} @dots{}), where each @var{keyword} is a |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2618 face attribute name and @var{value} is a meaningful value for that |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2619 attribute. With this feature, you do not need to create a face each |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2620 time you want to specify a particular attribute for certain text. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2621 @xref{Face Attributes}. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2622 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2623 @item |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2624 A cons cell of the form @code{(foreground-color . @var{color-name})} or |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2625 @code{(background-color . @var{color-name})}. These elements specify |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2626 just the foreground color or just the background color. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2627 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2628 @code{(foreground-color . @var{color-name})} is equivalent to |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2629 @code{(:foreground @var{color-name})}, and likewise for the background. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2630 @end itemize |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2631 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2632 @xref{Font Lock Mode}, for information on how to update @code{face} |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2633 properties automatically based on the contents of the text. |
6558 | 2634 |
2635 @item mouse-face | |
2636 @kindex mouse-face @r{(text property)} | |
2637 The property @code{mouse-face} is used instead of @code{face} when the | |
2638 mouse is on or near the character. For this purpose, ``near'' means | |
2639 that all text between the character and where the mouse is have the same | |
2640 @code{mouse-face} property value. | |
2641 | |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2642 @item fontified |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2643 @kindex fontified @r{(text property)} |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2644 This property, if non-@code{nil}, says that text in the buffer has |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2645 had faces assigned automatically by a feature such as Font-Lock mode. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2646 @xref{Auto Faces}. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2647 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2648 @item display |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2649 @kindex display @r{(text property)} |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2650 This property activates various features that change the |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2651 way text is displayed. For example, it can make text appear taller |
27374
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
2652 or shorter, higher or lower, wider or narrow, or replaced with an image. |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2653 @xref{Display Property}. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2654 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2655 @item help-echo |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2656 @kindex help-echo @r{(text property)} |
31079 | 2657 @anchor{Text help-echo} |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2658 If text has a string as its @code{help-echo} property, then when you |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2659 move the mouse onto that text, Emacs displays that string in the echo |
31079 | 2660 area, or in the tooltip window. |
2661 | |
31372 | 2662 If the value of the @code{help-echo} property is a function, that |
31079 | 2663 function is called with three arguments, @var{window}, @var{object} and |
31372 | 2664 @var{position} and should return a help string or @var{nil} for |
31079 | 2665 none. The first argument, @var{window} is the window in which |
2666 the help was found. The second, @var{object}, is the buffer, overlay or | |
2667 string which had the @code{help-echo} property. The @var{position} | |
2668 argument is as follows: | |
2669 | |
2670 @itemize @bullet{} | |
2671 @item | |
2672 If @var{object} is a buffer, @var{pos} is the position in the buffer | |
2673 where the @code{help-echo} text property was found. | |
2674 @item | |
2675 If @var{object} is an overlay, that overlay has a @code{help-echo} | |
2676 property, and @var{pos} is the position in the overlay's buffer under | |
2677 the mouse. | |
2678 @item | |
2679 If @var{object} is a string (an overlay string or a string displayed | |
31372 | 2680 with the @code{display} property), @var{pos} is the position in that |
31079 | 2681 string under the mouse. |
2682 @end itemize | |
2683 | |
2684 If the value of the @code{help-echo} property is neither a function nor | |
2685 a string, it is evaluated to obtain a help string. | |
2686 | |
31372 | 2687 You can alter the way help text is displayed by setting the variable |
2688 @code{show-help-function} (@pxref{Help display}). | |
31079 | 2689 |
2690 This feature is used in the mode line and for other active text. It is | |
2691 available starting in Emacs 21. | |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
2692 |
29102 | 2693 @item local-map |
6558 | 2694 @cindex keymap of character |
29102 | 2695 @kindex local-map @r{(text property)} |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2696 You can specify a different keymap for some of the text in a buffer by |
29102 | 2697 means of the @code{local-map} property. The property's value for the |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2698 character after point, if non-@code{nil}, is used for key lookup instead |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2699 of the buffer's local map. If the property value is a symbol, the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2700 symbol's function definition is used as the keymap. @xref{Active |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2701 Keymaps}. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2702 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2703 @item syntax-table |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2704 The @code{syntax-table} property overrides what the syntax table says |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2705 about this particular character. @xref{Syntax Properties}. |
6558 | 2706 |
2707 @item read-only | |
2708 @cindex read-only character | |
2709 @kindex read-only @r{(text property)} | |
2710 If a character has the property @code{read-only}, then modifying that | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2711 character is not allowed. Any command that would do so gets an error, |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2712 @code{text-read-only}. |
6558 | 2713 |
2714 Insertion next to a read-only character is an error if inserting | |
2715 ordinary text there would inherit the @code{read-only} property due to | |
2716 stickiness. Thus, you can control permission to insert next to | |
2717 read-only text by controlling the stickiness. @xref{Sticky Properties}. | |
2718 | |
2719 Since changing properties counts as modifying the buffer, it is not | |
2720 possible to remove a @code{read-only} property unless you know the | |
2721 special trick: bind @code{inhibit-read-only} to a non-@code{nil} value | |
2722 and then remove the property. @xref{Read Only Buffers}. | |
2723 | |
2724 @item invisible | |
2725 @kindex invisible @r{(text property)} | |
12067 | 2726 A non-@code{nil} @code{invisible} property can make a character invisible |
2727 on the screen. @xref{Invisible Text}, for details. | |
6558 | 2728 |
6782
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
2729 @item intangible |
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
2730 @kindex intangible @r{(text property)} |
12067 | 2731 If a group of consecutive characters have equal and non-@code{nil} |
2732 @code{intangible} properties, then you cannot place point between them. | |
12098 | 2733 If you try to move point forward into the group, point actually moves to |
2734 the end of the group. If you try to move point backward into the group, | |
12067 | 2735 point actually moves to the start of the group. |
2736 | |
2737 When the variable @code{inhibit-point-motion-hooks} is non-@code{nil}, | |
2738 the @code{intangible} property is ignored. | |
6782
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
2739 |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2740 @item field |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2741 @kindex field @r{(text property)} |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2742 Consecutive characters with the same @code{field} property constitute a |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2743 @dfn{field}. Some motion functions including @code{forward-word} and |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2744 @code{beginning-of-line} stop moving at a field boundary. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2745 @xref{Fields}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2746 |
6558 | 2747 @item modification-hooks |
2748 @cindex change hooks for a character | |
2749 @cindex hooks for changing a character | |
2750 @kindex modification-hooks @r{(text property)} | |
2751 If a character has the property @code{modification-hooks}, then its | |
2752 value should be a list of functions; modifying that character calls all | |
2753 of those functions. Each function receives two arguments: the beginning | |
2754 and end of the part of the buffer being modified. Note that if a | |
2755 particular modification hook function appears on several characters | |
2756 being modified by a single primitive, you can't predict how many times | |
2757 the function will be called. | |
2758 | |
2759 @item insert-in-front-hooks | |
2760 @itemx insert-behind-hooks | |
2761 @kindex insert-in-front-hooks @r{(text property)} | |
2762 @kindex insert-behind-hooks @r{(text property)} | |
16398
71e49abd5906
Clarify how insert-in-front-hooks and insert-behind-hooks are used.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15760
diff
changeset
|
2763 The operation of inserting text in a buffer also calls the functions |
71e49abd5906
Clarify how insert-in-front-hooks and insert-behind-hooks are used.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15760
diff
changeset
|
2764 listed in the @code{insert-in-front-hooks} property of the following |
71e49abd5906
Clarify how insert-in-front-hooks and insert-behind-hooks are used.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15760
diff
changeset
|
2765 character and in the @code{insert-behind-hooks} property of the |
71e49abd5906
Clarify how insert-in-front-hooks and insert-behind-hooks are used.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15760
diff
changeset
|
2766 preceding character. These functions receive two arguments, the |
71e49abd5906
Clarify how insert-in-front-hooks and insert-behind-hooks are used.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15760
diff
changeset
|
2767 beginning and end of the inserted text. The functions are called |
71e49abd5906
Clarify how insert-in-front-hooks and insert-behind-hooks are used.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
15760
diff
changeset
|
2768 @emph{after} the actual insertion takes place. |
6558 | 2769 |
2770 See also @ref{Change Hooks}, for other hooks that are called | |
2771 when you change text in a buffer. | |
2772 | |
2773 @item point-entered | |
2774 @itemx point-left | |
2775 @cindex hooks for motion of point | |
2776 @kindex point-entered @r{(text property)} | |
2777 @kindex point-left @r{(text property)} | |
2778 The special properties @code{point-entered} and @code{point-left} | |
2779 record hook functions that report motion of point. Each time point | |
2780 moves, Emacs compares these two property values: | |
2781 | |
2782 @itemize @bullet | |
2783 @item | |
2784 the @code{point-left} property of the character after the old location, | |
2785 and | |
2786 @item | |
2787 the @code{point-entered} property of the character after the new | |
2788 location. | |
2789 @end itemize | |
2790 | |
2791 @noindent | |
2792 If these two values differ, each of them is called (if not @code{nil}) | |
2793 with two arguments: the old value of point, and the new one. | |
2794 | |
2795 The same comparison is made for the characters before the old and new | |
2796 locations. The result may be to execute two @code{point-left} functions | |
2797 (which may be the same function) and/or two @code{point-entered} | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2798 functions (which may be the same function). In any case, all the |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2799 @code{point-left} functions are called first, followed by all the |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2800 @code{point-entered} functions. |
6558 | 2801 |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2802 It is possible using @code{char-after} to examine characters at various |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2803 positions without moving point to those positions. Only an actual |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2804 change in the value of point runs these hook functions. |
6558 | 2805 @end table |
2806 | |
2807 @defvar inhibit-point-motion-hooks | |
2808 When this variable is non-@code{nil}, @code{point-left} and | |
12067 | 2809 @code{point-entered} hooks are not run, and the @code{intangible} |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2810 property has no effect. Do not set this variable globally; bind it with |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2811 @code{let}. |
6558 | 2812 @end defvar |
2813 | |
31079 | 2814 @defvar show-help-function |
2815 @tindex show-help-function | |
31372 | 2816 @anchor{Help display} If this variable is non-@code{nil}, it specifies a |
2817 function called to display help strings. These may be @code{help-echo} | |
2818 properties, menu help strings (@pxref{Simple Menu Items}, | |
2819 @pxref{Extended Menu Items}), or tool bar help strings (@pxref{Tool | |
2820 Bar}). The specified function is called with one argument, the help | |
2821 string to display. Tooltip mode (@pxref{(emacs)Tooltips}) provides an | |
2822 example. | |
31079 | 2823 @end defvar |
2824 | |
12067 | 2825 @node Format Properties |
12098 | 2826 @subsection Formatted Text Properties |
12067 | 2827 |
2828 These text properties affect the behavior of the fill commands. They | |
12098 | 2829 are used for representing formatted text. @xref{Filling}, and |
2830 @ref{Margins}. | |
2831 | |
2832 @table @code | |
12067 | 2833 @item hard |
2834 If a newline character has this property, it is a ``hard'' newline. | |
2835 The fill commands do not alter hard newlines and do not move words | |
2836 across them. However, this property takes effect only if the variable | |
2837 @code{use-hard-newlines} is non-@code{nil}. | |
2838 | |
2839 @item right-margin | |
12098 | 2840 This property specifies an extra right margin for filling this part of the |
12067 | 2841 text. |
2842 | |
2843 @item left-margin | |
12098 | 2844 This property specifies an extra left margin for filling this part of the |
12067 | 2845 text. |
2846 | |
2847 @item justification | |
2848 This property specifies the style of justification for filling this part | |
2849 of the text. | |
2850 @end table | |
2851 | |
6558 | 2852 @node Sticky Properties |
2853 @subsection Stickiness of Text Properties | |
2854 @cindex sticky text properties | |
2855 @cindex inheritance of text properties | |
2856 | |
2857 Self-inserting characters normally take on the same properties as the | |
2858 preceding character. This is called @dfn{inheritance} of properties. | |
2859 | |
2860 In a Lisp program, you can do insertion with inheritance or without, | |
2861 depending on your choice of insertion primitive. The ordinary text | |
2862 insertion functions such as @code{insert} do not inherit any properties. | |
2863 They insert text with precisely the properties of the string being | |
2864 inserted, and no others. This is correct for programs that copy text | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2865 from one context to another---for example, into or out of the kill ring. |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2866 To insert with inheritance, use the special primitives described in this |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2867 section. Self-inserting characters inherit properties because they work |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2868 using these primitives. |
6558 | 2869 |
2870 When you do insertion with inheritance, @emph{which} properties are | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2871 inherited, and from where, depends on which properties are @dfn{sticky}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2872 Insertion after a character inherits those of its properties that are |
6558 | 2873 @dfn{rear-sticky}. Insertion before a character inherits those of its |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2874 properties that are @dfn{front-sticky}. When both sides offer different |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2875 sticky values for the same property, the previous character's value |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2876 takes precedence. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2877 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2878 By default, a text property is rear-sticky but not front-sticky; thus, |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2879 the default is to inherit all the properties of the preceding character, |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2880 and nothing from the following character. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2881 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2882 You can control the stickiness of various text properties with two |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2883 specific text properties, @code{front-sticky} and @code{rear-nonsticky}, |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2884 and with the variable @code{text-property-default-nonsticky}. You can |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2885 use the variable to specify a different default for a given property. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2886 You can use those two text properties to make any specific properties |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2887 sticky or nonsticky in any particular part of the text. |
6558 | 2888 |
2889 If a character's @code{front-sticky} property is @code{t}, then all | |
2890 its properties are front-sticky. If the @code{front-sticky} property is | |
2891 a list, then the sticky properties of the character are those whose | |
2892 names are in the list. For example, if a character has a | |
2893 @code{front-sticky} property whose value is @code{(face read-only)}, | |
2894 then insertion before the character can inherit its @code{face} property | |
2895 and its @code{read-only} property, but no others. | |
2896 | |
27374
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
2897 The @code{rear-nonsticky} property works the opposite way. Most |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
2898 properties are rear-sticky by default, so the @code{rear-nonsticky} |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
2899 property says which properties are @emph{not} rear-sticky. If a |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
2900 character's @code{rear-nonsticky} property is @code{t}, then none of its |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
2901 properties are rear-sticky. If the @code{rear-nonsticky} property is a |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
2902 list, properties are rear-sticky @emph{unless} their names are in the |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
2903 list. |
6558 | 2904 |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2905 @defvar text-property-default-nonsticky |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2906 @tindex text-property-default-nonsticky |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2907 This variable holds an alist which defines the default rear-stickiness |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2908 of various text properties. Each element has the form |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2909 @code{(@var{property} . @var{nonstickiness})}, and it defines the |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2910 stickiness of a particular text property, @var{property}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2911 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2912 If @var{nonstickiness} is non-@code{nil}, this means that the property |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2913 @var{property} is rear-nonsticky by default. Since all properties are |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2914 front-nonsticky by default, this makes @var{property} nonsticky in both |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2915 directions by default. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2916 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2917 The text properties @code{front-sticky} and @code{rear-nonsticky}, when |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2918 used, take precedence over the default @var{nonstickiness} specifed in |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2919 @code{text-property-default-nonsticky}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
2920 @end defvar |
6558 | 2921 |
2922 Here are the functions that insert text with inheritance of properties: | |
2923 | |
2924 @defun insert-and-inherit &rest strings | |
2925 Insert the strings @var{strings}, just like the function @code{insert}, | |
2926 but inherit any sticky properties from the adjoining text. | |
2927 @end defun | |
2928 | |
2929 @defun insert-before-markers-and-inherit &rest strings | |
2930 Insert the strings @var{strings}, just like the function | |
2931 @code{insert-before-markers}, but inherit any sticky properties from the | |
2932 adjoining text. | |
2933 @end defun | |
2934 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2935 @xref{Insertion}, for the ordinary insertion functions which do not |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2936 inherit. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2937 |
6558 | 2938 @node Saving Properties |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
2939 @subsection Saving Text Properties in Files |
6558 | 2940 @cindex text properties in files |
2941 @cindex saving text properties | |
2942 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2943 You can save text properties in files (along with the text itself), |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2944 and restore the same text properties when visiting or inserting the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2945 files, using these two hooks: |
6558 | 2946 |
12098 | 2947 @defvar write-region-annotate-functions |
6558 | 2948 This variable's value is a list of functions for @code{write-region} to |
2949 run to encode text properties in some fashion as annotations to the text | |
2950 being written in the file. @xref{Writing to Files}. | |
2951 | |
2952 Each function in the list is called with two arguments: the start and | |
2953 end of the region to be written. These functions should not alter the | |
2954 contents of the buffer. Instead, they should return lists indicating | |
2955 annotations to write in the file in addition to the text in the | |
2956 buffer. | |
2957 | |
2958 Each function should return a list of elements of the form | |
2959 @code{(@var{position} . @var{string})}, where @var{position} is an | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2960 integer specifying the relative position within the text to be written, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2961 and @var{string} is the annotation to add there. |
6558 | 2962 |
2963 Each list returned by one of these functions must be already sorted in | |
2964 increasing order by @var{position}. If there is more than one function, | |
2965 @code{write-region} merges the lists destructively into one sorted list. | |
2966 | |
2967 When @code{write-region} actually writes the text from the buffer to the | |
2968 file, it intermixes the specified annotations at the corresponding | |
2969 positions. All this takes place without modifying the buffer. | |
2970 @end defvar | |
2971 | |
2972 @defvar after-insert-file-functions | |
2973 This variable holds a list of functions for @code{insert-file-contents} | |
2974 to call after inserting a file's contents. These functions should scan | |
2975 the inserted text for annotations, and convert them to the text | |
2976 properties they stand for. | |
2977 | |
2978 Each function receives one argument, the length of the inserted text; | |
2979 point indicates the start of that text. The function should scan that | |
2980 text for annotations, delete them, and create the text properties that | |
2981 the annotations specify. The function should return the updated length | |
2982 of the inserted text, as it stands after those changes. The value | |
2983 returned by one function becomes the argument to the next function. | |
2984 | |
2985 These functions should always return with point at the beginning of | |
2986 the inserted text. | |
2987 | |
2988 The intended use of @code{after-insert-file-functions} is for converting | |
2989 some sort of textual annotations into actual text properties. But other | |
2990 uses may be possible. | |
2991 @end defvar | |
2992 | |
2993 We invite users to write Lisp programs to store and retrieve text | |
2994 properties in files, using these hooks, and thus to experiment with | |
2995 various data formats and find good ones. Eventually we hope users | |
2996 will produce good, general extensions we can install in Emacs. | |
2997 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2998 We suggest not trying to handle arbitrary Lisp objects as text property |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
2999 names or values---because a program that general is probably difficult |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3000 to write, and slow. Instead, choose a set of possible data types that |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3001 are reasonably flexible, and not too hard to encode. |
6558 | 3002 |
12098 | 3003 @xref{Format Conversion}, for a related feature. |
3004 | |
3005 @c ??? In next edition, merge this info Format Conversion. | |
3006 | |
15760
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3007 @node Lazy Properties |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3008 @subsection Lazy Computation of Text Properties |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3009 |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3010 Instead of computing text properties for all the text in the buffer, |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3011 you can arrange to compute the text properties for parts of the text |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3012 when and if something depends on them. |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3013 |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3014 The primitive that extracts text from the buffer along with its |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3015 properties is @code{buffer-substring}. Before examining the properties, |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3016 this function runs the abnormal hook @code{buffer-access-fontify-functions}. |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3017 |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3018 @defvar buffer-access-fontify-functions |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3019 This variable holds a list of functions for computing text properties. |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3020 Before @code{buffer-substring} copies the text and text properties for a |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3021 portion of the buffer, it calls all the functions in this list. Each of |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3022 the functions receives two arguments that specify the range of the |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3023 buffer being accessed. (The buffer itself is always the current |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3024 buffer.) |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3025 @end defvar |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3026 |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3027 The function @code{buffer-substring-no-properties} does not call these |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3028 functions, since it ignores text properties anyway. |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3029 |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3030 In order to prevent the hook functions from being called more than |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3031 once for the same part of the buffer, you can use the variable |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3032 @code{buffer-access-fontified-property}. |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3033 |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3034 @defvar buffer-access-fontified-property |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3035 If this value's variable is non-@code{nil}, it is a symbol which is used |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3036 as a text property name. A non-@code{nil} value for that text property |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3037 means, ``the other text properties for this character have already been |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3038 computed.'' |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3039 |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3040 If all the characters in the range specified for @code{buffer-substring} |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3041 have a non-@code{nil} value for this property, @code{buffer-substring} |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3042 does not call the @code{buffer-access-fontify-functions} functions. It |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3043 assumes these characters already have the right text properties, and |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3044 just copies the properties they already have. |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3045 |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3046 The normal way to use this feature is that the |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3047 @code{buffer-access-fontify-functions} functions add this property, as |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3048 well as others, to the characters they operate on. That way, they avoid |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3049 being called over and over for the same text. |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3050 @end defvar |
0489cb739a5f
(Lazy Properties): New node.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
13109
diff
changeset
|
3051 |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3052 @node Clickable Text |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3053 @subsection Defining Clickable Text |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3054 @cindex clickable text |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3055 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3056 There are two ways to set up @dfn{clickable text} in a buffer. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3057 There are typically two parts of this: to make the text highlight |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3058 when the mouse is over it, and to make a mouse button do something |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3059 when you click it on that part of the text. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3060 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3061 Highlighting is done with the @code{mouse-face} text property. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3062 Here is an example of how Dired does it: |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3063 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3064 @smallexample |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3065 (condition-case nil |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3066 (if (dired-move-to-filename) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3067 (put-text-property (point) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3068 (save-excursion |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3069 (dired-move-to-end-of-filename) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3070 (point)) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3071 'mouse-face 'highlight)) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3072 (error nil)) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3073 @end smallexample |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3074 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3075 @noindent |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3076 The first two arguments to @code{put-text-property} specify the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3077 beginning and end of the text. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3078 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3079 The usual way to make the mouse do something when you click it |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3080 on this text is to define @code{mouse-2} in the major mode's |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3081 keymap. The job of checking whether the click was on clickable text |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3082 is done by the command definition. Here is how Dired does it: |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3083 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3084 @smallexample |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3085 (defun dired-mouse-find-file-other-window (event) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3086 "In dired, visit the file or directory name you click on." |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3087 (interactive "e") |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3088 (let (file) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3089 (save-excursion |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3090 (set-buffer (window-buffer (posn-window (event-end event)))) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3091 (save-excursion |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3092 (goto-char (posn-point (event-end event))) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3093 (setq file (dired-get-filename)))) |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3094 (select-window (posn-window (event-end event))) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3095 (find-file-other-window (file-name-sans-versions file t)))) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3096 @end smallexample |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3097 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3098 @noindent |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3099 The reason for the outer @code{save-excursion} construct is to avoid |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3100 changing the current buffer; the reason for the inner one is to avoid |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3101 permanently altering point in the buffer you click on. In this case, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3102 Dired uses the function @code{dired-get-filename} to determine which |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3103 file to visit, based on the position found in the event. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3104 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3105 Instead of defining a mouse command for the major mode, you can define |
31586 | 3106 a key binding for the clickable text itself, using the @code{keymap} |
29102 | 3107 text property: |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3108 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3109 @example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3110 (let ((map (make-sparse-keymap))) |
31586 | 3111 (define-key map [mouse-2] 'operate-this-button) |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3112 (put-text-property (point) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3113 (save-excursion |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3114 (dired-move-to-end-of-filename) |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3115 (point)) |
31586 | 3116 'keymap map)) |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3117 @end example |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3118 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3119 @noindent |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3120 This method makes it possible to define different commands for various |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3121 clickable pieces of text. Also, the major mode definition (or the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3122 global definition) remains available for the rest of the text in the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3123 buffer. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3124 |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3125 @node Fields |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3126 @subsection Defining and Using Fields |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3127 @cindex fields |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3128 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3129 A field is a range of consecutive characters in the buffer that are |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3130 identified by having the same value (comparing with @code{eq}) of the |
32091 | 3131 @code{field} property (either a text-property or an overlay property). |
3132 This section describes special functions that are available for | |
3133 operating on fields. | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3134 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3135 You specify a field with a buffer position, @var{pos}. We think of |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3136 each field as containing a range of buffer positions, so the position |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3137 you specify stands for the field containing that position. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3138 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3139 When the characters before and after @var{pos} are part of the same |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3140 field, there is no doubt which field contains @var{pos}: the one those |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3141 characters both belong to. When @var{pos} is at a boundary between |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3142 fields, which field it belongs to depends on the stickiness of the |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3143 @code{field} properties of the two surrounding characters (@pxref{Sticky |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3144 Properties}). The field whose property would be inherited by text |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3145 inserted at @var{pos} is the field that contains @var{pos}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3146 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3147 There is an anomalous case where newly inserted text at @var{pos} |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3148 would not inherit the @code{field} property from either side. This |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3149 happens if the previous character's @code{field} property is not |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3150 rear-sticky, and the following character's @code{field} property is not |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3151 front-sticky. In this case, @var{pos} belongs to neither the preceding |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3152 field nor the following field; the field functions treat it as belonging |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3153 to an empty field whose beginning and end are both at @var{pos}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3154 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3155 In all of these functions, if @var{pos} is omitted or @code{nil}, the |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3156 value of point is used by default. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3157 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3158 @defun field-beginning &optional pos escape-from-edge |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3159 @tindex field-beginning |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3160 This function returns the beginning of the field specified by @var{pos}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3161 |
32091 | 3162 If @var{pos} is at the beginning of its field, and |
3163 @var{escape-from-edge} is non-@code{nil}, then the return value is | |
3164 always the beginning of the preceding field that @emph{ends} at @var{pos}, | |
3165 regardless of the stickiness of the @code{field} properties around | |
3166 @var{pos}. | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3167 @end defun |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3168 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3169 @defun field-end &optional pos escape-from-edge |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3170 @tindex field-end |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3171 This function returns the end of the field specified by @var{pos}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3172 |
32091 | 3173 If @var{pos} is at the end of its field, and @var{escape-from-edge} is |
3174 non-@code{nil}, then the return value is always the end of the following | |
3175 field that @emph{begins} at @var{pos}, regardless of the stickiness of | |
3176 the @code{field} properties around @var{pos}. | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3177 @end defun |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3178 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3179 @defun field-string &optional pos |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3180 @tindex field-string |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3181 This function returns the contents of the field specified by @var{pos}, |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3182 as a string. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3183 @end defun |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3184 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3185 @defun field-string-no-properties &optional pos |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3186 @tindex field-string-no-properties |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3187 This function returns the contents of the field specified by @var{pos}, |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3188 as a string, discarding text properties. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3189 @end defun |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3190 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3191 @defun delete-field &optional pos |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3192 @tindex delete-field |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3193 This function deletes the text of the field specified by @var{pos}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3194 @end defun |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3195 |
32091 | 3196 @defun constrain-to-field new-pos old-pos &optional escape-from-edge only-in-line inhibit-capture-property |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3197 @tindex constrain-to-field |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3198 This function ``constrains'' @var{new-pos} to the field that |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3199 @var{old-pos} belongs to---in other words, it returns the position |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3200 closest to @var{new-pos} that is in the same field as @var{old-pos}. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3201 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3202 If @var{new-pos} is @code{nil}, then @code{constrain-to-field} uses |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3203 the value of point instead, and moves point to the resulting position. |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3204 |
27374
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3205 If @var{old-pos} is at the boundary of two fields, then the acceptable |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3206 positions for @var{new-pos} depend on the value of the optional argument |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3207 @var{escape-from-edge}. If @var{escape-from-edge} is @code{nil}, then |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3208 @var{new-pos} is constrained to the field that has the same @code{field} |
32091 | 3209 property (either a text-property or an overlay property) that new |
3210 characters inserted at @var{old-pos} would get. (This depends on the | |
3211 stickiness of the @code{field} property for the characters before and | |
3212 after @var{old-pos}.) If @var{escape-from-edge} is non-@code{nil}, | |
3213 @var{new-pos} is constrained to the union of the two adjacent fields. | |
3214 Additionally, if two fields are separated by another field with the | |
3215 special value @code{boundary}, then any point within this special field | |
3216 is also considered to be ``on the boundary.'' | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3217 |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3218 If the optional argument @var{only-in-line} is non-@code{nil}, and |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3219 constraining @var{new-pos} in the usual way would move it to a different |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3220 line, @var{new-pos} is returned unconstrained. This used in commands |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3221 that move by line, such as @code{next-line} and |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3222 @code{beginning-of-line}, so that they respect field boundaries only in |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3223 the case where they can still move to the right line. |
32091 | 3224 |
3225 If the optional argument @var{inhibit-capture-property} is | |
3226 non-@code{nil}, and @var{old-pos} has a non-@code{nil} property of that | |
3227 name, then any field boundaries are ignored. | |
3228 | |
3229 You can cause @code{constrain-to-field} to ignore all field boundaries | |
3230 (and so never constrain anything) by binding the variable | |
3231 @code{inhibit-field-text-motion} to a non-nil value. | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3232 @end defun |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3233 |
6558 | 3234 @node Not Intervals |
3235 @subsection Why Text Properties are not Intervals | |
3236 @cindex intervals | |
3237 | |
3238 Some editors that support adding attributes to text in the buffer do | |
3239 so by letting the user specify ``intervals'' within the text, and adding | |
3240 the properties to the intervals. Those editors permit the user or the | |
3241 programmer to determine where individual intervals start and end. We | |
3242 deliberately provided a different sort of interface in Emacs Lisp to | |
3243 avoid certain paradoxical behavior associated with text modification. | |
3244 | |
3245 If the actual subdivision into intervals is meaningful, that means you | |
3246 can distinguish between a buffer that is just one interval with a | |
3247 certain property, and a buffer containing the same text subdivided into | |
3248 two intervals, both of which have that property. | |
3249 | |
3250 Suppose you take the buffer with just one interval and kill part of | |
3251 the text. The text remaining in the buffer is one interval, and the | |
3252 copy in the kill ring (and the undo list) becomes a separate interval. | |
3253 Then if you yank back the killed text, you get two intervals with the | |
3254 same properties. Thus, editing does not preserve the distinction | |
3255 between one interval and two. | |
3256 | |
3257 Suppose we ``fix'' this problem by coalescing the two intervals when | |
3258 the text is inserted. That works fine if the buffer originally was a | |
3259 single interval. But suppose instead that we have two adjacent | |
3260 intervals with the same properties, and we kill the text of one interval | |
3261 and yank it back. The same interval-coalescence feature that rescues | |
3262 the other case causes trouble in this one: after yanking, we have just | |
3263 one interval. One again, editing does not preserve the distinction | |
3264 between one interval and two. | |
3265 | |
3266 Insertion of text at the border between intervals also raises | |
3267 questions that have no satisfactory answer. | |
3268 | |
3269 However, it is easy to arrange for editing to behave consistently for | |
3270 questions of the form, ``What are the properties of this character?'' | |
3271 So we have decided these are the only questions that make sense; we have | |
3272 not implemented asking questions about where intervals start or end. | |
3273 | |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3274 In practice, you can usually use the text property search functions in |
6558 | 3275 place of explicit interval boundaries. You can think of them as finding |
3276 the boundaries of intervals, assuming that intervals are always | |
3277 coalesced whenever possible. @xref{Property Search}. | |
3278 | |
3279 Emacs also provides explicit intervals as a presentation feature; see | |
3280 @ref{Overlays}. | |
3281 | |
3282 @node Substitution | |
3283 @section Substituting for a Character Code | |
3284 | |
3285 The following functions replace characters within a specified region | |
3286 based on their character codes. | |
3287 | |
3288 @defun subst-char-in-region start end old-char new-char &optional noundo | |
3289 @cindex replace characters | |
3290 This function replaces all occurrences of the character @var{old-char} | |
3291 with the character @var{new-char} in the region of the current buffer | |
3292 defined by @var{start} and @var{end}. | |
3293 | |
3294 @cindex undo avoidance | |
12098 | 3295 If @var{noundo} is non-@code{nil}, then @code{subst-char-in-region} does |
3296 not record the change for undo and does not mark the buffer as modified. | |
26696
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3297 This was useful for controlling the old selective display feature |
ef5e7bbe6f19
Current version from /gd/gnu/elisp.
Dave Love <fx@gnu.org>
parents:
25875
diff
changeset
|
3298 (@pxref{Selective Display}). |
6558 | 3299 |
3300 @code{subst-char-in-region} does not move point and returns | |
3301 @code{nil}. | |
3302 | |
3303 @example | |
3304 @group | |
3305 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
3306 This is the contents of the buffer before. | |
3307 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
3308 @end group | |
3309 | |
3310 @group | |
3311 (subst-char-in-region 1 20 ?i ?X) | |
3312 @result{} nil | |
3313 | |
3314 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
3315 ThXs Xs the contents of the buffer before. | |
3316 ---------- Buffer: foo ---------- | |
3317 @end group | |
3318 @end example | |
3319 @end defun | |
3320 | |
3321 @defun translate-region start end table | |
3322 This function applies a translation table to the characters in the | |
3323 buffer between positions @var{start} and @var{end}. | |
3324 | |
3325 The translation table @var{table} is a string; @code{(aref @var{table} | |
3326 @var{ochar})} gives the translated character corresponding to | |
3327 @var{ochar}. If the length of @var{table} is less than 256, any | |
3328 characters with codes larger than the length of @var{table} are not | |
3329 altered by the translation. | |
3330 | |
3331 The return value of @code{translate-region} is the number of | |
8427
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
3332 characters that were actually changed by the translation. This does |
bc548090f760
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
7735
diff
changeset
|
3333 not count characters that were mapped into themselves in the |
6558 | 3334 translation table. |
3335 @end defun | |
3336 | |
3337 @node Registers | |
3338 @section Registers | |
3339 @cindex registers | |
3340 | |
3341 A register is a sort of variable used in Emacs editing that can hold a | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3342 variety of different kinds of values. Each register is named by a |
27374
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3343 single character. All @sc{ascii} characters and their meta variants |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3344 (but with the exception of @kbd{C-g}) can be used to name registers. |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3345 Thus, there are 255 possible registers. A register is designated in |
0f5edee5242b
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
27189
diff
changeset
|
3346 Emacs Lisp by the character that is its name. |
6558 | 3347 |
3348 @defvar register-alist | |
3349 This variable is an alist of elements of the form @code{(@var{name} . | |
3350 @var{contents})}. Normally, there is one element for each Emacs | |
3351 register that has been used. | |
3352 | |
3353 The object @var{name} is a character (an integer) identifying the | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3354 register. |
6558 | 3355 @end defvar |
3356 | |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3357 The @var{contents} of a register can have several possible types: |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3358 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3359 @table @asis |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3360 @item a number |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3361 A number stands for itself. If @code{insert-register} finds a number |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3362 in the register, it converts the number to decimal. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3363 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3364 @item a marker |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3365 A marker represents a buffer position to jump to. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3366 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3367 @item a string |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3368 A string is text saved in the register. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3369 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3370 @item a rectangle |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3371 A rectangle is represented by a list of strings. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3372 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3373 @item @code{(@var{window-configuration} @var{position})} |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3374 This represents a window configuration to restore in one frame, and a |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3375 position to jump to in the current buffer. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3376 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3377 @item @code{(@var{frame-configuration} @var{position})} |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3378 This represents a frame configuration to restore, and a position |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3379 to jump to in the current buffer. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3380 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3381 @item (file @var{filename}) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3382 This represents a file to visit; jumping to this value visits file |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3383 @var{filename}. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3384 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3385 @item (file-query @var{filename} @var{position}) |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3386 This represents a file to visit and a position in it; jumping to this |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3387 value visits file @var{filename} and goes to buffer position |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3388 @var{position}. Restoring this type of position asks the user for |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3389 confirmation first. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3390 @end table |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3391 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3392 The functions in this section return unpredictable values unless |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3393 otherwise stated. |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3394 |
6558 | 3395 @defun get-register reg |
3396 This function returns the contents of the register | |
3397 @var{reg}, or @code{nil} if it has no contents. | |
3398 @end defun | |
3399 | |
3400 @defun set-register reg value | |
3401 This function sets the contents of register @var{reg} to @var{value}. | |
3402 A register can be set to any value, but the other register functions | |
3403 expect only certain data types. The return value is @var{value}. | |
3404 @end defun | |
3405 | |
3406 @deffn Command view-register reg | |
3407 This command displays what is contained in register @var{reg}. | |
3408 @end deffn | |
3409 | |
3410 @ignore | |
3411 @deffn Command point-to-register reg | |
3412 This command stores both the current location of point and the current | |
3413 buffer in register @var{reg} as a marker. | |
3414 @end deffn | |
3415 | |
3416 @deffn Command jump-to-register reg | |
3417 @deffnx Command register-to-point reg | |
3418 @comment !!SourceFile register.el | |
3419 This command restores the status recorded in register @var{reg}. | |
3420 | |
3421 If @var{reg} contains a marker, it moves point to the position stored in | |
3422 the marker. Since both the buffer and the location within the buffer | |
3423 are stored by the @code{point-to-register} function, this command can | |
3424 switch you to another buffer. | |
3425 | |
3426 If @var{reg} contains a window configuration or a frame configuration. | |
3427 @code{jump-to-register} restores that configuration. | |
3428 @end deffn | |
3429 @end ignore | |
3430 | |
3431 @deffn Command insert-register reg &optional beforep | |
3432 This command inserts contents of register @var{reg} into the current | |
3433 buffer. | |
3434 | |
3435 Normally, this command puts point before the inserted text, and the | |
3436 mark after it. However, if the optional second argument @var{beforep} | |
3437 is non-@code{nil}, it puts the mark before and point after. | |
3438 You can pass a non-@code{nil} second argument @var{beforep} to this | |
3439 function interactively by supplying any prefix argument. | |
3440 | |
3441 If the register contains a rectangle, then the rectangle is inserted | |
3442 with its upper left corner at point. This means that text is inserted | |
3443 in the current line and underneath it on successive lines. | |
3444 | |
3445 If the register contains something other than saved text (a string) or | |
3446 a rectangle (a list), currently useless things happen. This may be | |
3447 changed in the future. | |
3448 @end deffn | |
3449 | |
3450 @ignore | |
3451 @deffn Command copy-to-register reg start end &optional delete-flag | |
3452 This command copies the region from @var{start} to @var{end} into | |
3453 register @var{reg}. If @var{delete-flag} is non-@code{nil}, it deletes | |
3454 the region from the buffer after copying it into the register. | |
3455 @end deffn | |
3456 | |
3457 @deffn Command prepend-to-register reg start end &optional delete-flag | |
3458 This command prepends the region from @var{start} to @var{end} into | |
3459 register @var{reg}. If @var{delete-flag} is non-@code{nil}, it deletes | |
3460 the region from the buffer after copying it to the register. | |
3461 @end deffn | |
3462 | |
3463 @deffn Command append-to-register reg start end &optional delete-flag | |
3464 This command appends the region from @var{start} to @var{end} to the | |
3465 text already in register @var{reg}. If @var{delete-flag} is | |
3466 non-@code{nil}, it deletes the region from the buffer after copying it | |
3467 to the register. | |
3468 @end deffn | |
3469 | |
3470 @deffn Command copy-rectangle-to-register reg start end &optional delete-flag | |
3471 This command copies a rectangular region from @var{start} to @var{end} | |
3472 into register @var{reg}. If @var{delete-flag} is non-@code{nil}, it | |
3473 deletes the region from the buffer after copying it to the register. | |
3474 @end deffn | |
3475 | |
3476 @deffn Command window-configuration-to-register reg | |
3477 This function stores the window configuration of the selected frame in | |
3478 register @var{reg}. | |
3479 @end deffn | |
3480 | |
3481 @deffn Command frame-configuration-to-register reg | |
3482 This function stores the current frame configuration in register | |
3483 @var{reg}. | |
3484 @end deffn | |
3485 @end ignore | |
3486 | |
7735
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3487 @node Transposition |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3488 @section Transposition of Text |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3489 |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3490 This subroutine is used by the transposition commands. |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3491 |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3492 @defun transpose-regions start1 end1 start2 end2 &optional leave-markers |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3493 This function exchanges two nonoverlapping portions of the buffer. |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3494 Arguments @var{start1} and @var{end1} specify the bounds of one portion |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3495 and arguments @var{start2} and @var{end2} specify the bounds of the |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3496 other portion. |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3497 |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3498 Normally, @code{transpose-regions} relocates markers with the transposed |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3499 text; a marker previously positioned within one of the two transposed |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3500 portions moves along with that portion, thus remaining between the same |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3501 two characters in their new position. However, if @var{leave-markers} |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3502 is non-@code{nil}, @code{transpose-regions} does not do this---it leaves |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3503 all markers unrelocated. |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3504 @end defun |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3505 |
24951
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3506 @node Base 64 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3507 @section Base 64 Encoding |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3508 @cindex base 64 encoding |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3509 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3510 Base 64 code is used in email to encode a sequence of 8-bit bytes as a |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3511 longer sequence of @sc{ascii} graphic characters. This section |
24951
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3512 describes the functions for converting to and from this code. |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3513 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3514 @defun base64-encode-region beg end &optional no-line-break |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3515 @tindex base64-encode-region |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3516 This function converts the region from @var{beg} to @var{end} |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3517 into base 64 code. It returns the length of the encoded text. |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3518 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3519 Normally, this function inserts newline characters into the encoded |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3520 text, to avoid overlong lines. However, if the optional argument |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3521 @var{no-line-break} is non-@code{nil}, these newlines are not added, so |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3522 the output is just one long line. |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3523 @end defun |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3524 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3525 @defun base64-encode-string string &optional no-line-break |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3526 @tindex base64-encode-string |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3527 This function converts the string @var{string} into base 64 code. It |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3528 returns a string containing the encoded text. |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3529 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3530 Normally, this function inserts newline characters into the encoded |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3531 text, to avoid overlong lines. However, if the optional argument |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3532 @var{no-line-break} is non-@code{nil}, these newlines are not added, so |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3533 the result string is just one long line. |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3534 @end defun |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3535 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3536 @defun base64-decode-region beg end |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3537 @tindex base64-decode-region |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3538 This function converts the region from @var{beg} to @var{end} from base |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3539 64 code into the corresponding decoded text. It returns the length of |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3540 the decoded text. |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3541 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3542 The decoding functions ignore newline characters in the encoded text. |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3543 @end defun |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3544 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3545 @defun base64-decode-string string |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3546 @tindex base64-decode-string |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3547 This function converts the string @var{string} from base 64 code into |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3548 the corresponding decoded text. It returns a string containing the |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3549 decoded text. |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3550 |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3551 The decoding functions ignore newline characters in the encoded text. |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3552 @end defun |
7451b1458af1
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
23147
diff
changeset
|
3553 |
6558 | 3554 @node Change Hooks |
3555 @section Change Hooks | |
3556 @cindex change hooks | |
3557 @cindex hooks for text changes | |
3558 | |
3559 These hook variables let you arrange to take notice of all changes in | |
3560 all buffers (or in a particular buffer, if you make them buffer-local). | |
3561 See also @ref{Special Properties}, for how to detect changes to specific | |
3562 parts of the text. | |
3563 | |
3564 The functions you use in these hooks should save and restore the match | |
3565 data if they do anything that uses regular expressions; otherwise, they | |
3566 will interfere in bizarre ways with the editing operations that call | |
3567 them. | |
3568 | |
6782
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
3569 @defvar before-change-functions |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3570 This variable holds a list of functions to call before any buffer |
6782
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
3571 modification. Each function gets two arguments, the beginning and end |
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
3572 of the region that is about to change, represented as integers. The |
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
3573 buffer that is about to change is always the current buffer. |
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
3574 @end defvar |
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
3575 |
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
3576 @defvar after-change-functions |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3577 This variable holds a list of functions to call after any buffer |
6782
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
3578 modification. Each function receives three arguments: the beginning and |
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
3579 end of the region just changed, and the length of the text that existed |
19467
d76f57ca7aba
Explain after-change-functions and chars vs bytes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18339
diff
changeset
|
3580 before the change. All three arguments are integers. The buffer that's |
d76f57ca7aba
Explain after-change-functions and chars vs bytes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18339
diff
changeset
|
3581 about to change is always the current buffer. |
d76f57ca7aba
Explain after-change-functions and chars vs bytes.
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
18339
diff
changeset
|
3582 |
22252
40089afa2b1d
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
22138
diff
changeset
|
3583 The length of the old text is the difference between the buffer positions |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
3584 before and after that text as it was before the change. As for the |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
3585 changed text, its length is simply the difference between the first two |
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
3586 arguments. |
6782
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
3587 @end defvar |
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
3588 |
22138
d4ac295a98b3
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21682
diff
changeset
|
3589 @defmac combine-after-change-calls body... |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3590 The macro executes @var{body} normally, but arranges to call the |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3591 after-change functions just once for a series of several changes---if |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3592 that seems safe. |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3593 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3594 If a program makes several text changes in the same area of the buffer, |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3595 using the macro @code{combine-after-change-calls} around that part of |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3596 the program can make it run considerably faster when after-change hooks |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3597 are in use. When the after-change hooks are ultimately called, the |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3598 arguments specify a portion of the buffer including all of the changes |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3599 made within the @code{combine-after-change-calls} body. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3600 |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3601 @strong{Warning:} You must not alter the values of |
31079 | 3602 @code{after-change-functions} within |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3603 the body of a @code{combine-after-change-calls} form. |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3604 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3605 @strong{Note:} If the changes you combine occur in widely scattered |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3606 parts of the buffer, this will still work, but it is not advisable, |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3607 because it may lead to inefficient behavior for some change hook |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3608 functions. |
21007
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3609 @end defmac |
66d807bdc5b4
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
19467
diff
changeset
|
3610 |
31079 | 3611 The two variables above are temporarily bound to @code{nil} during the |
6782
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
3612 time that any of these functions is running. This means that if one of |
6558 | 3613 these functions changes the buffer, that change won't run these |
6782
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
3614 functions. If you do want a hook function to make changes that run |
5b07647ec8f7
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6558
diff
changeset
|
3615 these functions, make it bind these variables back to their usual |
6558 | 3616 values. |
3617 | |
7735
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3618 One inconvenient result of this protective feature is that you cannot |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3619 have a function in @code{after-change-functions} or |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3620 @code{before-change-functions} which changes the value of that variable. |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3621 But that's not a real limitation. If you want those functions to change |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3622 the list of functions to run, simply add one fixed function to the hook, |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3623 and code that function to look in another variable for other functions |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3624 to call. Here is an example: |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3625 |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3626 @example |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3627 (setq my-own-after-change-functions nil) |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3628 (defun indirect-after-change-function (beg end len) |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3629 (let ((list my-own-after-change-functions)) |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3630 (while list |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3631 (funcall (car list) beg end len) |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3632 (setq list (cdr list))))) |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3633 |
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3634 @group |
7735
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3635 (add-hooks 'after-change-functions |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3636 'indirect-after-change-function) |
21682
90da2489c498
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
21007
diff
changeset
|
3637 @end group |
7735
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3638 @end example |
7db892210924
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
6782
diff
changeset
|
3639 |
6558 | 3640 @defvar first-change-hook |
3641 This variable is a normal hook that is run whenever a buffer is changed | |
3642 that was previously in the unmodified state. | |
3643 @end defvar | |
25751
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3644 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3645 @defvar inhibit-modification-hooks |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3646 @tindex inhibit-modification-hooks |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3647 If this variable is non-@code{nil}, all of the change hooks are |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3648 disabled; none of them run. This affects all the hook variables |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3649 described above in this section, as well as the hooks attached to |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3650 certain special text properties (@pxref{Special Properties}) and overlay |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3651 properties (@pxref{Overlay Properties}). |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3652 |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3653 This variable is available starting in Emacs 21. |
467b88fab665
*** empty log message ***
Richard M. Stallman <rms@gnu.org>
parents:
25454
diff
changeset
|
3654 @end defvar |